Logo Search packages:      
Sourcecode: ia32-libs version File versions

reload1.c

/* Reload pseudo regs into hard regs for insns that require hard regs.
   Copyright (C) 1987, 88, 89, 92-97, 1998 Free Software Foundation, Inc.

This file is part of GNU CC.

GNU CC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
any later version.

GNU CC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
GNU General Public License for more details.

You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with GNU CC; see the file COPYING.  If not, write to
the Free Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.  */


#include "config.h"
#include "system.h"

#include "machmode.h"
#include "hard-reg-set.h"
#include "rtl.h"
#include "obstack.h"
#include "insn-config.h"
#include "insn-flags.h"
#include "insn-codes.h"
#include "flags.h"
#include "expr.h"
#include "regs.h"
#include "reload.h"
#include "recog.h"
#include "basic-block.h"
#include "output.h"
#include "real.h"
#include "toplev.h"

/* This file contains the reload pass of the compiler, which is
   run after register allocation has been done.  It checks that
   each insn is valid (operands required to be in registers really
   are in registers of the proper class) and fixes up invalid ones
   by copying values temporarily into registers for the insns
   that need them.

   The results of register allocation are described by the vector
   reg_renumber; the insns still contain pseudo regs, but reg_renumber
   can be used to find which hard reg, if any, a pseudo reg is in.

   The technique we always use is to free up a few hard regs that are
   called ``reload regs'', and for each place where a pseudo reg
   must be in a hard reg, copy it temporarily into one of the reload regs.

   All the pseudos that were formerly allocated to the hard regs that
   are now in use as reload regs must be ``spilled''.  This means
   that they go to other hard regs, or to stack slots if no other
   available hard regs can be found.  Spilling can invalidate more
   insns, requiring additional need for reloads, so we must keep checking
   until the process stabilizes.

   For machines with different classes of registers, we must keep track
   of the register class needed for each reload, and make sure that
   we allocate enough reload registers of each class.

   The file reload.c contains the code that checks one insn for
   validity and reports the reloads that it needs.  This file
   is in charge of scanning the entire rtl code, accumulating the
   reload needs, spilling, assigning reload registers to use for
   fixing up each insn, and generating the new insns to copy values
   into the reload registers.  */


#ifndef REGISTER_MOVE_COST
#define REGISTER_MOVE_COST(x, y) 2
#endif

/* During reload_as_needed, element N contains a REG rtx for the hard reg
   into which reg N has been reloaded (perhaps for a previous insn).  */
static rtx *reg_last_reload_reg;

/* Elt N nonzero if reg_last_reload_reg[N] has been set in this insn
   for an output reload that stores into reg N.  */
static char *reg_has_output_reload;

/* Indicates which hard regs are reload-registers for an output reload
   in the current insn.  */
static HARD_REG_SET reg_is_output_reload;

/* Element N is the constant value to which pseudo reg N is equivalent,
   or zero if pseudo reg N is not equivalent to a constant.
   find_reloads looks at this in order to replace pseudo reg N
   with the constant it stands for.  */
rtx *reg_equiv_constant;

/* Element N is a memory location to which pseudo reg N is equivalent,
   prior to any register elimination (such as frame pointer to stack
   pointer).  Depending on whether or not it is a valid address, this value
   is transferred to either reg_equiv_address or reg_equiv_mem.  */
rtx *reg_equiv_memory_loc;

/* Element N is the address of stack slot to which pseudo reg N is equivalent.
   This is used when the address is not valid as a memory address
   (because its displacement is too big for the machine.)  */
rtx *reg_equiv_address;

/* Element N is the memory slot to which pseudo reg N is equivalent,
   or zero if pseudo reg N is not equivalent to a memory slot.  */
rtx *reg_equiv_mem;

/* Widest width in which each pseudo reg is referred to (via subreg).  */
static int *reg_max_ref_width;

/* Element N is the insn that initialized reg N from its equivalent
   constant or memory slot.  */
static rtx *reg_equiv_init;

/* During reload_as_needed, element N contains the last pseudo regno reloaded
  into hard register N.  If that pseudo reg occupied more than one register,
   reg_reloaded_contents points to that pseudo for each spill register in
   use; all of these must remain set for an inheritance to occur.  */
static int reg_reloaded_contents[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];

/* During reload_as_needed, element N contains the insn for which
   hard register N was last used.   Its contents are significant only
   when reg_reloaded_valid is set for this register.  */
static rtx reg_reloaded_insn[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];

/* Indicate if reg_reloaded_insn / reg_reloaded_contents is valid */
static HARD_REG_SET reg_reloaded_valid;
/* Indicate if the register was dead at the end of the reload.
   This is only valid if reg_reloaded_contents is set and valid.  */
static HARD_REG_SET reg_reloaded_dead;

/* Number of spill-regs so far; number of valid elements of spill_regs.  */
static int n_spills;

/* In parallel with spill_regs, contains REG rtx's for those regs.
   Holds the last rtx used for any given reg, or 0 if it has never
   been used for spilling yet.  This rtx is reused, provided it has
   the proper mode.  */
static rtx spill_reg_rtx[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];

/* In parallel with spill_regs, contains nonzero for a spill reg
   that was stored after the last time it was used.
   The precise value is the insn generated to do the store.  */
static rtx spill_reg_store[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];

/* This table is the inverse mapping of spill_regs:
   indexed by hard reg number,
   it contains the position of that reg in spill_regs,
   or -1 for something that is not in spill_regs.  */
static short spill_reg_order[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];

/* This reg set indicates registers that may not be used for retrying global
   allocation.  The registers that may not be used include all spill registers
   and the frame pointer (if we are using one).  */
HARD_REG_SET forbidden_regs;

/* This reg set indicates registers that are not good for spill registers.
   They will not be used to complete groups of spill registers.  This includes
   all fixed registers, registers that may be eliminated, and, if
   SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES is zero, registers explicitly used in the rtl.

   (spill_reg_order prevents these registers from being used to start a
   group.)  */
static HARD_REG_SET bad_spill_regs;

/* Describes order of use of registers for reloading
   of spilled pseudo-registers.  `spills' is the number of
   elements that are actually valid; new ones are added at the end.  */
static short spill_regs[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];

/* This reg set indicates those registers that have been used a spill
   registers.  This information is used in reorg.c, to help figure out
   what registers are live at any point.  It is assumed that all spill_regs
   are dead at every CODE_LABEL.  */

HARD_REG_SET used_spill_regs;

/* Index of last register assigned as a spill register.  We allocate in
   a round-robin fashion.  */

static int last_spill_reg;

/* Describes order of preference for putting regs into spill_regs.
   Contains the numbers of all the hard regs, in order most preferred first.
   This order is different for each function.
   It is set up by order_regs_for_reload.
   Empty elements at the end contain -1.  */
static short potential_reload_regs[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];

/* 1 for a hard register that appears explicitly in the rtl
   (for example, function value registers, special registers
   used by insns, structure value pointer registers).  */
static char regs_explicitly_used[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];

/* Indicates if a register was counted against the need for
   groups.  0 means it can count against max_nongroup instead.  */
static HARD_REG_SET counted_for_groups;

/* Indicates if a register was counted against the need for
   non-groups.  0 means it can become part of a new group.
   During choose_reload_regs, 1 here means don't use this reg
   as part of a group, even if it seems to be otherwise ok.  */
static HARD_REG_SET counted_for_nongroups;

/* Nonzero if indirect addressing is supported on the machine; this means
   that spilling (REG n) does not require reloading it into a register in
   order to do (MEM (REG n)) or (MEM (PLUS (REG n) (CONST_INT c))).  The
   value indicates the level of indirect addressing supported, e.g., two
   means that (MEM (MEM (REG n))) is also valid if (REG n) does not get
   a hard register.  */

static char spill_indirect_levels;

/* Nonzero if indirect addressing is supported when the innermost MEM is
   of the form (MEM (SYMBOL_REF sym)).  It is assumed that the level to
   which these are valid is the same as spill_indirect_levels, above.   */

char indirect_symref_ok;

/* Nonzero if an address (plus (reg frame_pointer) (reg ...)) is valid.  */

char double_reg_address_ok;

/* Record the stack slot for each spilled hard register.  */

static rtx spill_stack_slot[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];

/* Width allocated so far for that stack slot.  */

static int spill_stack_slot_width[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];

/* Indexed by register class and basic block number, nonzero if there is
   any need for a spill register of that class in that basic block.
   The pointer is 0 if we did stupid allocation and don't know
   the structure of basic blocks.  */

char *basic_block_needs[N_REG_CLASSES];

/* First uid used by insns created by reload in this function.
   Used in find_equiv_reg.  */
int reload_first_uid;

/* Flag set by local-alloc or global-alloc if anything is live in
   a call-clobbered reg across calls.  */

int caller_save_needed;

/* The register class to use for a base register when reloading an
   address.  This is normally BASE_REG_CLASS, but it may be different
   when using SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES and passing parameters in
   registers.  */
enum reg_class reload_address_base_reg_class;

/* The register class to use for an index register when reloading an
   address.  This is normally INDEX_REG_CLASS, but it may be different
   when using SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES and passing parameters in
   registers.  */
enum reg_class reload_address_index_reg_class;

/* Set to 1 while reload_as_needed is operating.
   Required by some machines to handle any generated moves differently.  */

int reload_in_progress = 0;

/* These arrays record the insn_code of insns that may be needed to
   perform input and output reloads of special objects.  They provide a
   place to pass a scratch register.  */

enum insn_code reload_in_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
enum insn_code reload_out_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];

/* This obstack is used for allocation of rtl during register elimination.
   The allocated storage can be freed once find_reloads has processed the
   insn.  */

struct obstack reload_obstack;
char *reload_firstobj;

#define obstack_chunk_alloc xmalloc
#define obstack_chunk_free free

/* List of labels that must never be deleted.  */
extern rtx forced_labels;

/* Allocation number table from global register allocation.  */
extern int *reg_allocno;

/* This structure is used to record information about register eliminations.
   Each array entry describes one possible way of eliminating a register
   in favor of another.   If there is more than one way of eliminating a
   particular register, the most preferred should be specified first.  */

static struct elim_table
{
  int from;             /* Register number to be eliminated.  */
  int to;               /* Register number used as replacement.  */
  int initial_offset;         /* Initial difference between values.  */
  int can_eliminate;          /* Non-zero if this elimination can be done.  */
  int can_eliminate_previous; /* Value of CAN_ELIMINATE in previous scan over
                           insns made by reload.  */
  int offset;                 /* Current offset between the two regs.  */
  int max_offset;       /* Maximum offset between the two regs.  */
  int previous_offset;        /* Offset at end of previous insn.  */
  int ref_outside_mem;        /* "to" has been referenced outside a MEM.  */
  rtx from_rtx;               /* REG rtx for the register to be eliminated.
                           We cannot simply compare the number since
                           we might then spuriously replace a hard
                           register corresponding to a pseudo
                           assigned to the reg to be eliminated.  */
  rtx to_rtx;                 /* REG rtx for the replacement.  */
} reg_eliminate[] =

/* If a set of eliminable registers was specified, define the table from it.
   Otherwise, default to the normal case of the frame pointer being
   replaced by the stack pointer.  */

#ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
  ELIMINABLE_REGS;
#else
  {{ FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}};
#endif

#define NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS (sizeof reg_eliminate / sizeof reg_eliminate[0])

/* Record the number of pending eliminations that have an offset not equal
   to their initial offset.  If non-zero, we use a new copy of each
   replacement result in any insns encountered.  */
static int num_not_at_initial_offset;

/* Count the number of registers that we may be able to eliminate.  */
static int num_eliminable;

/* For each label, we record the offset of each elimination.  If we reach
   a label by more than one path and an offset differs, we cannot do the
   elimination.  This information is indexed by the number of the label.
   The first table is an array of flags that records whether we have yet
   encountered a label and the second table is an array of arrays, one
   entry in the latter array for each elimination.  */

static char *offsets_known_at;
static int (*offsets_at)[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];

/* Number of labels in the current function.  */

static int num_labels;

struct hard_reg_n_uses { int regno; int uses; };

static int possible_group_p         PROTO((int, int *));
static void count_possible_groups   PROTO((int *, enum machine_mode *,
                                     int *, int));
static int modes_equiv_for_class_p  PROTO((enum machine_mode,
                                     enum machine_mode,
                                     enum reg_class));
static void spill_failure           PROTO((rtx));
static int new_spill_reg            PROTO((int, int, int *, int *, int,
                                     FILE *));
static void delete_dead_insn        PROTO((rtx));
static void alter_reg               PROTO((int, int));
static void mark_scratch_live       PROTO((rtx));
static void set_label_offsets       PROTO((rtx, rtx, int));
static int eliminate_regs_in_insn   PROTO((rtx, int));
static void mark_not_eliminable           PROTO((rtx, rtx));
static int spill_hard_reg           PROTO((int, int, FILE *, int));
static void scan_paradoxical_subregs      PROTO((rtx));
static int hard_reg_use_compare           PROTO((const GENERIC_PTR, const GENERIC_PTR));
static void order_regs_for_reload   PROTO((int));
static int compare_spill_regs       PROTO((const GENERIC_PTR, const GENERIC_PTR));
static void reload_as_needed        PROTO((rtx, int));
static void forget_old_reloads_1    PROTO((rtx, rtx));
static int reload_reg_class_lower   PROTO((const GENERIC_PTR, const GENERIC_PTR));
static void mark_reload_reg_in_use  PROTO((int, int, enum reload_type,
                                     enum machine_mode));
static void clear_reload_reg_in_use PROTO((int, int, enum reload_type,
                                     enum machine_mode));
static int reload_reg_free_p        PROTO((int, int, enum reload_type));
static int reload_reg_free_before_p PROTO((int, int, enum reload_type));
static int reload_reg_free_for_value_p    PROTO((int, int, enum reload_type, rtx, rtx, int));
static int reload_reg_reaches_end_p PROTO((int, int, enum reload_type));
static int allocate_reload_reg            PROTO((int, rtx, int, int));
static void choose_reload_regs            PROTO((rtx, rtx));
static void merge_assigned_reloads  PROTO((rtx));
static void emit_reload_insns       PROTO((rtx));
static void delete_output_reload    PROTO((rtx, int, rtx));
static void inc_for_reload          PROTO((rtx, rtx, int));
static int constraint_accepts_reg_p PROTO((char *, rtx));
static void reload_cse_invalidate_regno   PROTO((int, enum machine_mode, int));
static int reload_cse_mem_conflict_p      PROTO((rtx, rtx));
static void reload_cse_invalidate_mem     PROTO((rtx));
static void reload_cse_invalidate_rtx     PROTO((rtx, rtx));
static int reload_cse_regno_equal_p PROTO((int, rtx, enum machine_mode));
static int reload_cse_noop_set_p    PROTO((rtx, rtx));
static int reload_cse_simplify_set  PROTO((rtx, rtx));
static int reload_cse_simplify_operands   PROTO((rtx));
static void reload_cse_check_clobber      PROTO((rtx, rtx));
static void reload_cse_record_set   PROTO((rtx, rtx));
static void reload_cse_delete_death_notes PROTO((rtx));
static void reload_cse_no_longer_dead     PROTO((int, enum machine_mode));

/* Initialize the reload pass once per compilation.  */

void
init_reload ()
{
  register int i;

  /* Often (MEM (REG n)) is still valid even if (REG n) is put on the stack.
     Set spill_indirect_levels to the number of levels such addressing is
     permitted, zero if it is not permitted at all.  */

  register rtx tem
    = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode,
               gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
                         gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER + 1),
                         GEN_INT (4)));
  spill_indirect_levels = 0;

  while (memory_address_p (QImode, tem))
    {
      spill_indirect_levels++;
      tem = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, tem);
    }

  /* See if indirect addressing is valid for (MEM (SYMBOL_REF ...)).  */

  tem = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, "foo"));
  indirect_symref_ok = memory_address_p (QImode, tem);

  /* See if reg+reg is a valid (and offsettable) address.  */

  for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
    {
      tem = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
                    gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM),
                    gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, i));
      /* This way, we make sure that reg+reg is an offsettable address.  */
      tem = plus_constant (tem, 4);

      if (memory_address_p (QImode, tem))
      {
        double_reg_address_ok = 1;
        break;
      }
    }

  /* Initialize obstack for our rtl allocation.  */
  gcc_obstack_init (&reload_obstack);
  reload_firstobj = (char *) obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack, 0);

  /* Decide which register class should be used when reloading
     addresses.  If we are using SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES, and any
     parameters are passed in registers, then we do not want to use
     those registers when reloading an address.  Otherwise, if a
     function argument needs a reload, we may wind up clobbering
     another argument to the function which was already computed.  If
     we find a subset class which simply avoids those registers, we
     use it instead.  ??? It would be better to only use the
     restricted class when we actually are loading function arguments,
     but that is hard to determine.  */
  reload_address_base_reg_class = BASE_REG_CLASS;
  reload_address_index_reg_class = INDEX_REG_CLASS;
  if (SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES)
    {
      int regno;
      HARD_REG_SET base, index;
      enum reg_class *p;

      COPY_HARD_REG_SET (base, reg_class_contents[BASE_REG_CLASS]);
      COPY_HARD_REG_SET (index, reg_class_contents[INDEX_REG_CLASS]);
      for (regno = 0; regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; regno++)
      {
        if (FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (regno))
          {
            CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (base, regno);
            CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (index, regno);
          }
      }
      
      GO_IF_HARD_REG_EQUAL (base, reg_class_contents[BASE_REG_CLASS],
                      baseok);
      for (p = reg_class_subclasses[BASE_REG_CLASS];
         *p != LIM_REG_CLASSES;
         p++)
      {
        GO_IF_HARD_REG_EQUAL (base, reg_class_contents[*p], usebase);
        continue;
      usebase:
        reload_address_base_reg_class = *p;
        break;
      }
    baseok:;

      GO_IF_HARD_REG_EQUAL (index, reg_class_contents[INDEX_REG_CLASS],
                      indexok);
      for (p = reg_class_subclasses[INDEX_REG_CLASS];
         *p != LIM_REG_CLASSES;
         p++)
      {
        GO_IF_HARD_REG_EQUAL (index, reg_class_contents[*p], useindex);
        continue;
      useindex:
        reload_address_index_reg_class = *p;
        break;
      }
    indexok:;
    }
}

/* Main entry point for the reload pass.

   FIRST is the first insn of the function being compiled.

   GLOBAL nonzero means we were called from global_alloc
   and should attempt to reallocate any pseudoregs that we
   displace from hard regs we will use for reloads.
   If GLOBAL is zero, we do not have enough information to do that,
   so any pseudo reg that is spilled must go to the stack.

   DUMPFILE is the global-reg debugging dump file stream, or 0.
   If it is nonzero, messages are written to it to describe
   which registers are seized as reload regs, which pseudo regs
   are spilled from them, and where the pseudo regs are reallocated to.

   Return value is nonzero if reload failed
   and we must not do any more for this function.  */

int
reload (first, global, dumpfile)
     rtx first;
     int global;
     FILE *dumpfile;
{
  register int class;
  register int i, j, k;
  register rtx insn;
  register struct elim_table *ep;

  /* The two pointers used to track the true location of the memory used
     for label offsets.  */
  char *real_known_ptr = NULL_PTR;
  int (*real_at_ptr)[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];

  int something_changed;
  int something_needs_reloads;
  int something_needs_elimination;
  int new_basic_block_needs;
  enum reg_class caller_save_spill_class = NO_REGS;
  int caller_save_group_size = 1;

  /* Nonzero means we couldn't get enough spill regs.  */
  int failure = 0;

  /* The basic block number currently being processed for INSN.  */
  int this_block;

  /* Make sure even insns with volatile mem refs are recognizable.  */
  init_recog ();

  /* Enable find_equiv_reg to distinguish insns made by reload.  */
  reload_first_uid = get_max_uid ();

  for (i = 0; i < N_REG_CLASSES; i++)
    basic_block_needs[i] = 0;

#ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
  /* Initialize the secondary memory table.  */
  clear_secondary_mem ();
#endif

  /* Remember which hard regs appear explicitly
     before we merge into `regs_ever_live' the ones in which
     pseudo regs have been allocated.  */
  bcopy (regs_ever_live, regs_explicitly_used, sizeof regs_ever_live);

  /* We don't have a stack slot for any spill reg yet.  */
  bzero ((char *) spill_stack_slot, sizeof spill_stack_slot);
  bzero ((char *) spill_stack_slot_width, sizeof spill_stack_slot_width);

  /* Initialize the save area information for caller-save, in case some
     are needed.  */
  init_save_areas ();

  /* Compute which hard registers are now in use
     as homes for pseudo registers.
     This is done here rather than (eg) in global_alloc
     because this point is reached even if not optimizing.  */
  for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
    mark_home_live (i);

  /* A function that receives a nonlocal goto must save all call-saved
     registers.  */
  if (current_function_has_nonlocal_label)
    for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
      {
      if (! call_used_regs[i] && ! fixed_regs[i])
        regs_ever_live[i] = 1;
      }

  for (i = 0; i < scratch_list_length; i++)
    if (scratch_list[i])
      mark_scratch_live (scratch_list[i]);

  /* Make sure that the last insn in the chain
     is not something that needs reloading.  */
  emit_note (NULL_PTR, NOTE_INSN_DELETED);

  /* Find all the pseudo registers that didn't get hard regs
     but do have known equivalent constants or memory slots.
     These include parameters (known equivalent to parameter slots)
     and cse'd or loop-moved constant memory addresses.

     Record constant equivalents in reg_equiv_constant
     so they will be substituted by find_reloads.
     Record memory equivalents in reg_mem_equiv so they can
     be substituted eventually by altering the REG-rtx's.  */

  reg_equiv_constant = (rtx *) alloca (max_regno * sizeof (rtx));
  bzero ((char *) reg_equiv_constant, max_regno * sizeof (rtx));
  reg_equiv_memory_loc = (rtx *) alloca (max_regno * sizeof (rtx));
  bzero ((char *) reg_equiv_memory_loc, max_regno * sizeof (rtx));
  reg_equiv_mem = (rtx *) alloca (max_regno * sizeof (rtx));
  bzero ((char *) reg_equiv_mem, max_regno * sizeof (rtx));
  reg_equiv_init = (rtx *) alloca (max_regno * sizeof (rtx));
  bzero ((char *) reg_equiv_init, max_regno * sizeof (rtx));
  reg_equiv_address = (rtx *) alloca (max_regno * sizeof (rtx));
  bzero ((char *) reg_equiv_address, max_regno * sizeof (rtx));
  reg_max_ref_width = (int *) alloca (max_regno * sizeof (int));
  bzero ((char *) reg_max_ref_width, max_regno * sizeof (int));

  if (SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES)
    CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (forbidden_regs);

  /* Look for REG_EQUIV notes; record what each pseudo is equivalent to.
     Also find all paradoxical subregs and find largest such for each pseudo.
     On machines with small register classes, record hard registers that
     are used for user variables.  These can never be used for spills. 
     Also look for a "constant" NOTE_INSN_SETJMP.  This means that all
     caller-saved registers must be marked live.  */

  for (insn = first; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
    {
      rtx set = single_set (insn);

      if (GET_CODE (insn) == NOTE && CONST_CALL_P (insn)
        && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_SETJMP)
      for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
        if (! call_used_regs[i])
          regs_ever_live[i] = 1;

      if (set != 0 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) == REG)
      {
        rtx note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUIV, NULL_RTX);
        if (note
#ifdef LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P
            && (! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (note, 0)) || ! flag_pic
              || LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (XEXP (note, 0)))
#endif
            )
          {
            rtx x = XEXP (note, 0);
            i = REGNO (SET_DEST (set));
            if (i > LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER)
            {
              if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM)
                {
                  /* If the operand is a PLUS, the MEM may be shared,
                   so make sure we have an unshared copy here.  */
                  if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS)
                  x = copy_rtx (x);

                  reg_equiv_memory_loc[i] = x;
                }
              else if (CONSTANT_P (x))
                {
                  if (LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (x))
                  reg_equiv_constant[i] = x;
                  else
                  reg_equiv_memory_loc[i]
                    = force_const_mem (GET_MODE (SET_DEST (set)), x);
                }
              else
                continue;

              /* If this register is being made equivalent to a MEM
                 and the MEM is not SET_SRC, the equivalencing insn
                 is one with the MEM as a SET_DEST and it occurs later.
                 So don't mark this insn now.  */
              if (GET_CODE (x) != MEM
                  || rtx_equal_p (SET_SRC (set), x))
                reg_equiv_init[i] = insn;
            }
          }
      }

      /* If this insn is setting a MEM from a register equivalent to it,
       this is the equivalencing insn.  */
      else if (set && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) == MEM
             && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) == REG
             && reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (SET_SRC (set))]
             && rtx_equal_p (SET_DEST (set),
                         reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (SET_SRC (set))]))
      reg_equiv_init[REGNO (SET_SRC (set))] = insn;

      if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (insn)) == 'i')
      scan_paradoxical_subregs (PATTERN (insn));
    }

  /* Does this function require a frame pointer?  */

  frame_pointer_needed = (! flag_omit_frame_pointer
#ifdef EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
                    /* ?? If EXIT_IGNORE_STACK is set, we will not save
                       and restore sp for alloca.  So we can't eliminate
                       the frame pointer in that case.  At some point,
                       we should improve this by emitting the
                       sp-adjusting insns for this case.  */
                    || (current_function_calls_alloca
                        && EXIT_IGNORE_STACK)
#endif
                    || FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED);

  num_eliminable = 0;

  /* Initialize the table of registers to eliminate.  The way we do this
     depends on how the eliminable registers were defined.  */
#ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
  for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
    {
      ep->can_eliminate = ep->can_eliminate_previous
      = (CAN_ELIMINATE (ep->from, ep->to)
         && ! (ep->to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM && frame_pointer_needed));
    }
#else
  reg_eliminate[0].can_eliminate = reg_eliminate[0].can_eliminate_previous
    = ! frame_pointer_needed;
#endif

  /* Count the number of eliminable registers and build the FROM and TO
     REG rtx's.  Note that code in gen_rtx will cause, e.g.,
     gen_rtx (REG, Pmode, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM) to equal stack_pointer_rtx.
     We depend on this.  */
  for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
    {
      num_eliminable += ep->can_eliminate;
      ep->from_rtx = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, ep->from);
      ep->to_rtx = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, ep->to);
    }

  num_labels = max_label_num () - get_first_label_num ();

  /* Allocate the tables used to store offset information at labels.  */
  /* We used to use alloca here, but the size of what it would try to
     allocate would occasionally cause it to exceed the stack limit and
     cause a core dump.  */
  real_known_ptr = xmalloc (num_labels);
  real_at_ptr
    = (int (*)[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS])
    xmalloc (num_labels * NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS * sizeof (int));

  offsets_known_at = real_known_ptr - get_first_label_num ();
  offsets_at
    = (int (*)[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]) (real_at_ptr - get_first_label_num ());

  /* Alter each pseudo-reg rtx to contain its hard reg number.
     Assign stack slots to the pseudos that lack hard regs or equivalents.
     Do not touch virtual registers.  */

  for (i = LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER + 1; i < max_regno; i++)
    alter_reg (i, -1);

  /* If we have some registers we think can be eliminated, scan all insns to
     see if there is an insn that sets one of these registers to something
     other than itself plus a constant.  If so, the register cannot be
     eliminated.  Doing this scan here eliminates an extra pass through the
     main reload loop in the most common case where register elimination
     cannot be done.  */
  for (insn = first; insn && num_eliminable; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
    if (GET_CODE (insn) == INSN || GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN
      || GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
      note_stores (PATTERN (insn), mark_not_eliminable);

#ifndef REGISTER_CONSTRAINTS
  /* If all the pseudo regs have hard regs,
     except for those that are never referenced,
     we know that no reloads are needed.  */
  /* But that is not true if there are register constraints, since
     in that case some pseudos might be in the wrong kind of hard reg.  */

  for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
    if (reg_renumber[i] == -1 && REG_N_REFS (i) != 0)
      break;

  if (i == max_regno && num_eliminable == 0 && ! caller_save_needed)
    {
      free (real_known_ptr);
      free (real_at_ptr);
      return;
    }
#endif

  /* Compute the order of preference for hard registers to spill.
     Store them by decreasing preference in potential_reload_regs.  */

  order_regs_for_reload (global);

  /* So far, no hard regs have been spilled.  */
  n_spills = 0;
  for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
    spill_reg_order[i] = -1;

  /* Initialize to -1, which means take the first spill register.  */
  last_spill_reg = -1;

  /* On most machines, we can't use any register explicitly used in the
     rtl as a spill register.  But on some, we have to.  Those will have
     taken care to keep the life of hard regs as short as possible.  */

  if (! SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES)
    COPY_HARD_REG_SET (forbidden_regs, bad_spill_regs);

  /* Spill any hard regs that we know we can't eliminate.  */
  for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
    if (! ep->can_eliminate)
      spill_hard_reg (ep->from, global, dumpfile, 1);

#if HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
  if (frame_pointer_needed)
    spill_hard_reg (HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, global, dumpfile, 1);
#endif

  if (global)
    for (i = 0; i < N_REG_CLASSES; i++)
      {
      basic_block_needs[i] = (char *) alloca (n_basic_blocks);
      bzero (basic_block_needs[i], n_basic_blocks);
      }

  /* From now on, we need to emit any moves without making new pseudos.  */
  reload_in_progress = 1;

  /* This loop scans the entire function each go-round
     and repeats until one repetition spills no additional hard regs.  */

  /* This flag is set when a pseudo reg is spilled,
     to require another pass.  Note that getting an additional reload
     reg does not necessarily imply any pseudo reg was spilled;
     sometimes we find a reload reg that no pseudo reg was allocated in.  */
  something_changed = 1;
  /* This flag is set if there are any insns that require reloading.  */
  something_needs_reloads = 0;
  /* This flag is set if there are any insns that require register
     eliminations.  */
  something_needs_elimination = 0;
  while (something_changed)
    {
      rtx after_call = 0;

      /* For each class, number of reload regs needed in that class.
       This is the maximum over all insns of the needs in that class
       of the individual insn.  */
      int max_needs[N_REG_CLASSES];
      /* For each class, size of group of consecutive regs
       that is needed for the reloads of this class.  */
      int group_size[N_REG_CLASSES];
      /* For each class, max number of consecutive groups needed.
       (Each group contains group_size[CLASS] consecutive registers.)  */
      int max_groups[N_REG_CLASSES];
      /* For each class, max number needed of regs that don't belong
       to any of the groups.  */
      int max_nongroups[N_REG_CLASSES];
      /* For each class, the machine mode which requires consecutive
       groups of regs of that class.
       If two different modes ever require groups of one class,
       they must be the same size and equally restrictive for that class,
       otherwise we can't handle the complexity.  */
      enum machine_mode group_mode[N_REG_CLASSES];
      /* Record the insn where each maximum need is first found.  */
      rtx max_needs_insn[N_REG_CLASSES];
      rtx max_groups_insn[N_REG_CLASSES];
      rtx max_nongroups_insn[N_REG_CLASSES];
      rtx x;
      HOST_WIDE_INT starting_frame_size;
#if HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
      int previous_frame_pointer_needed = frame_pointer_needed;
#endif
      static char *reg_class_names[] = REG_CLASS_NAMES;

      something_changed = 0;
      bzero ((char *) max_needs, sizeof max_needs);
      bzero ((char *) max_groups, sizeof max_groups);
      bzero ((char *) max_nongroups, sizeof max_nongroups);
      bzero ((char *) max_needs_insn, sizeof max_needs_insn);
      bzero ((char *) max_groups_insn, sizeof max_groups_insn);
      bzero ((char *) max_nongroups_insn, sizeof max_nongroups_insn);
      bzero ((char *) group_size, sizeof group_size);
      for (i = 0; i < N_REG_CLASSES; i++)
      group_mode[i] = VOIDmode;

      /* Keep track of which basic blocks are needing the reloads.  */
      this_block = 0;

      /* Remember whether any element of basic_block_needs
       changes from 0 to 1 in this pass.  */
      new_basic_block_needs = 0;

      /* Round size of stack frame to BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT.  This must be done
       here because the stack size may be a part of the offset computation
       for register elimination, and there might have been new stack slots
       created in the last iteration of this loop.   */
      assign_stack_local (BLKmode, 0, 0);

      starting_frame_size = get_frame_size ();

      /* Reset all offsets on eliminable registers to their initial values.  */
#ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
      for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
      {
        INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (ep->from, ep->to, ep->initial_offset);
        ep->previous_offset = ep->offset
          = ep->max_offset = ep->initial_offset;
      }
#else
#ifdef INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET
      INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (reg_eliminate[0].initial_offset);
#else
      if (!FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED)
      abort ();
      reg_eliminate[0].initial_offset = 0;
#endif
      reg_eliminate[0].previous_offset = reg_eliminate[0].max_offset
      = reg_eliminate[0].offset = reg_eliminate[0].initial_offset;
#endif

      num_not_at_initial_offset = 0;

      bzero ((char *) &offsets_known_at[get_first_label_num ()], num_labels);

      /* Set a known offset for each forced label to be at the initial offset
       of each elimination.  We do this because we assume that all
       computed jumps occur from a location where each elimination is
       at its initial offset.  */

      for (x = forced_labels; x; x = XEXP (x, 1))
      if (XEXP (x, 0))
        set_label_offsets (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX, 1);

      /* For each pseudo register that has an equivalent location defined,
       try to eliminate any eliminable registers (such as the frame pointer)
       assuming initial offsets for the replacement register, which
       is the normal case.

       If the resulting location is directly addressable, substitute
       the MEM we just got directly for the old REG.

       If it is not addressable but is a constant or the sum of a hard reg
       and constant, it is probably not addressable because the constant is
       out of range, in that case record the address; we will generate
       hairy code to compute the address in a register each time it is
       needed.  Similarly if it is a hard register, but one that is not
       valid as an address register.

       If the location is not addressable, but does not have one of the
       above forms, assign a stack slot.  We have to do this to avoid the
       potential of producing lots of reloads if, e.g., a location involves
       a pseudo that didn't get a hard register and has an equivalent memory
       location that also involves a pseudo that didn't get a hard register.

       Perhaps at some point we will improve reload_when_needed handling
       so this problem goes away.  But that's very hairy.  */

      for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
      if (reg_renumber[i] < 0 && reg_equiv_memory_loc[i])
        {
          rtx x = eliminate_regs (reg_equiv_memory_loc[i], 0, NULL_RTX);

          if (strict_memory_address_p (GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]),
                               XEXP (x, 0)))
            reg_equiv_mem[i] = x, reg_equiv_address[i] = 0;
          else if (CONSTANT_P (XEXP (x, 0))
                 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG
                   && REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
                 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
                   && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)) == REG
                   && (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0))
                       < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
                   && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1))))
            reg_equiv_address[i] = XEXP (x, 0), reg_equiv_mem[i] = 0;
          else
            {
            /* Make a new stack slot.  Then indicate that something
               changed so we go back and recompute offsets for
               eliminable registers because the allocation of memory
               below might change some offset.  reg_equiv_{mem,address}
               will be set up for this pseudo on the next pass around
               the loop.  */
            reg_equiv_memory_loc[i] = 0;
            reg_equiv_init[i] = 0;
            alter_reg (i, -1);
            something_changed = 1;
            }
        }

      /* If we allocated another pseudo to the stack, redo elimination
       bookkeeping.  */
      if (something_changed)
      continue;

      /* If caller-saves needs a group, initialize the group to include
       the size and mode required for caller-saves.  */

      if (caller_save_group_size > 1)
      {
        group_mode[(int) caller_save_spill_class] = Pmode;
        group_size[(int) caller_save_spill_class] = caller_save_group_size;
      }

      /* Compute the most additional registers needed by any instruction.
       Collect information separately for each class of regs.  */

      for (insn = first; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
      {
        if (global && this_block + 1 < n_basic_blocks
            && insn == basic_block_head[this_block+1])
          ++this_block;

        /* If this is a label, a JUMP_INSN, or has REG_NOTES (which
           might include REG_LABEL), we need to see what effects this
           has on the known offsets at labels.  */

        if (GET_CODE (insn) == CODE_LABEL || GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN
            || (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (insn)) == 'i'
              && REG_NOTES (insn) != 0))
          set_label_offsets (insn, insn, 0);

        if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (insn)) == 'i')
          {
            /* Nonzero means don't use a reload reg that overlaps
             the place where a function value can be returned.  */
            rtx avoid_return_reg = 0;

            rtx old_body = PATTERN (insn);
            int old_code = INSN_CODE (insn);
            rtx old_notes = REG_NOTES (insn);
            int did_elimination = 0;

            /* To compute the number of reload registers of each class 
             needed for an insn, we must simulate what choose_reload_regs
             can do.  We do this by splitting an insn into an "input" and
             an "output" part.  RELOAD_OTHER reloads are used in both. 
             The input part uses those reloads, RELOAD_FOR_INPUT reloads,
             which must be live over the entire input section of reloads,
             and the maximum of all the RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS and
             RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reloads, which conflict with the
             inputs.

             The registers needed for output are RELOAD_OTHER and
             RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT, which are live for the entire output
             portion, and the maximum of all the RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS
             reloads for each operand.

             The total number of registers needed is the maximum of the
             inputs and outputs.  */

            struct needs
            {
              /* [0] is normal, [1] is nongroup.  */
              int regs[2][N_REG_CLASSES];
              int groups[N_REG_CLASSES];
            };

            /* Each `struct needs' corresponds to one RELOAD_... type.  */
            struct {
            struct needs other;
            struct needs input;
            struct needs output;
            struct needs insn;
            struct needs other_addr;
            struct needs op_addr;
            struct needs op_addr_reload;
            struct needs in_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
            struct needs in_addr_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
            struct needs out_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
            struct needs out_addr_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
            } insn_needs;

            /* If needed, eliminate any eliminable registers.  */
            if (num_eliminable)
            did_elimination = eliminate_regs_in_insn (insn, 0);

            /* Set avoid_return_reg if this is an insn
             that might use the value of a function call.  */
            if (SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES && GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
            {
              if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
                after_call = SET_DEST (PATTERN (insn));
              else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
                     && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, 0)) == SET)
                after_call = SET_DEST (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, 0));
              else
                after_call = 0;
            }
            else if (SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES && after_call != 0
                   && !(GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET
                      && SET_DEST (PATTERN (insn)) == stack_pointer_rtx)
                   && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != USE)
            {
              if (reg_referenced_p (after_call, PATTERN (insn)))
                avoid_return_reg = after_call;
              after_call = 0;
            }

            /* Analyze the instruction.  */
            find_reloads (insn, 0, spill_indirect_levels, global,
                      spill_reg_order);

            /* Remember for later shortcuts which insns had any reloads or
             register eliminations.

             One might think that it would be worthwhile to mark insns
             that need register replacements but not reloads, but this is
             not safe because find_reloads may do some manipulation of
             the insn (such as swapping commutative operands), which would
             be lost when we restore the old pattern after register
             replacement.  So the actions of find_reloads must be redone in
             subsequent passes or in reload_as_needed.

             However, it is safe to mark insns that need reloads
             but not register replacement.  */

            PUT_MODE (insn, (did_elimination ? QImode
                         : n_reloads ? HImode
                         : GET_MODE (insn) == DImode ? DImode
                         : VOIDmode));

            /* Discard any register replacements done.  */
            if (did_elimination)
            {
              obstack_free (&reload_obstack, reload_firstobj);
              PATTERN (insn) = old_body;
              INSN_CODE (insn) = old_code;
              REG_NOTES (insn) = old_notes;
              something_needs_elimination = 1;
            }

            /* If this insn has no reloads, we need not do anything except
             in the case of a CALL_INSN when we have caller-saves and
             caller-save needs reloads.  */

            if (n_reloads == 0
              && ! (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN
                  && caller_save_spill_class != NO_REGS))
            continue;

            something_needs_reloads = 1;
            bzero ((char *) &insn_needs, sizeof insn_needs);

            /* Count each reload once in every class
             containing the reload's own class.  */

            for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
            {
              register enum reg_class *p;
              enum reg_class class = reload_reg_class[i];
              int size;
              enum machine_mode mode;
              struct needs *this_needs;

              /* Don't count the dummy reloads, for which one of the
                 regs mentioned in the insn can be used for reloading.
                 Don't count optional reloads.
                 Don't count reloads that got combined with others.  */
              if (reload_reg_rtx[i] != 0
                  || reload_optional[i] != 0
                  || (reload_out[i] == 0 && reload_in[i] == 0
                    && ! reload_secondary_p[i]))
                continue;

              /* Show that a reload register of this class is needed
                 in this basic block.  We do not use insn_needs and
                 insn_groups because they are overly conservative for
                 this purpose.  */
              if (global && ! basic_block_needs[(int) class][this_block])
                {
                  basic_block_needs[(int) class][this_block] = 1;
                  new_basic_block_needs = 1;
                }

              mode = reload_inmode[i];
              if (GET_MODE_SIZE (reload_outmode[i]) > GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
                mode = reload_outmode[i];
              size = CLASS_MAX_NREGS (class, mode);

              /* Decide which time-of-use to count this reload for.  */
              switch (reload_when_needed[i])
                {
                case RELOAD_OTHER:
                  this_needs = &insn_needs.other;
                  break;
                case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
                  this_needs = &insn_needs.input;
                  break;
                case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
                  this_needs = &insn_needs.output;
                  break;
                case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
                  this_needs = &insn_needs.insn;
                  break;
                case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
                  this_needs = &insn_needs.other_addr;
                  break;
                case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
                  this_needs = &insn_needs.in_addr[reload_opnum[i]];
                  break;
                case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
                  this_needs = &insn_needs.in_addr_addr[reload_opnum[i]];
                  break;
                case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
                  this_needs = &insn_needs.out_addr[reload_opnum[i]];
                  break;
                case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
                  this_needs = &insn_needs.out_addr_addr[reload_opnum[i]];
                  break;
                case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
                  this_needs = &insn_needs.op_addr;
                  break;
                case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
                  this_needs = &insn_needs.op_addr_reload;
                  break;
                }

              if (size > 1)
                {
                  enum machine_mode other_mode, allocate_mode;

                  /* Count number of groups needed separately from
                   number of individual regs needed.  */
                  this_needs->groups[(int) class]++;
                  p = reg_class_superclasses[(int) class];
                  while (*p != LIM_REG_CLASSES)
                  this_needs->groups[(int) *p++]++;

                  /* Record size and mode of a group of this class.  */
                  /* If more than one size group is needed,
                   make all groups the largest needed size.  */
                  if (group_size[(int) class] < size)
                  {
                    other_mode = group_mode[(int) class];
                    allocate_mode = mode;

                    group_size[(int) class] = size;
                    group_mode[(int) class] = mode;
                  }
                  else
                  {
                    other_mode = mode;
                    allocate_mode = group_mode[(int) class];
                  }

                  /* Crash if two dissimilar machine modes both need
                   groups of consecutive regs of the same class.  */

                  if (other_mode != VOIDmode && other_mode != allocate_mode
                    && ! modes_equiv_for_class_p (allocate_mode,
                                          other_mode, class))
                  fatal_insn ("Two dissimilar machine modes both need groups of consecutive regs of the same class",
                            insn);
                }
              else if (size == 1)
                {
                  this_needs->regs[reload_nongroup[i]][(int) class] += 1;
                  p = reg_class_superclasses[(int) class];
                  while (*p != LIM_REG_CLASSES)
                  this_needs->regs[reload_nongroup[i]][(int) *p++] += 1;
                }
              else
                abort ();
            }

            /* All reloads have been counted for this insn;
             now merge the various times of use.
             This sets insn_needs, etc., to the maximum total number
             of registers needed at any point in this insn.  */

            for (i = 0; i < N_REG_CLASSES; i++)
            {
              int in_max, out_max;

              /* Compute normal and nongroup needs.  */
              for (j = 0; j <= 1; j++)
                {
                  for (in_max = 0, out_max = 0, k = 0;
                     k < reload_n_operands; k++)
                  {
                    in_max
                      = MAX (in_max,
                           (insn_needs.in_addr[k].regs[j][i]
                            + insn_needs.in_addr_addr[k].regs[j][i]));
                    out_max
                      = MAX (out_max, insn_needs.out_addr[k].regs[j][i]);
                    out_max
                      = MAX (out_max,
                           insn_needs.out_addr_addr[k].regs[j][i]);
                  }

                  /* RELOAD_FOR_INSN reloads conflict with inputs, outputs,
                   and operand addresses but not things used to reload
                   them.  Similarly, RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reloads
                   don't conflict with things needed to reload inputs or
                   outputs.  */

                  in_max = MAX (MAX (insn_needs.op_addr.regs[j][i],
                               insn_needs.op_addr_reload.regs[j][i]),
                            in_max);

                  out_max = MAX (out_max, insn_needs.insn.regs[j][i]);

                  insn_needs.input.regs[j][i]
                  = MAX (insn_needs.input.regs[j][i]
                         + insn_needs.op_addr.regs[j][i]
                         + insn_needs.insn.regs[j][i],
                         in_max + insn_needs.input.regs[j][i]);

                  insn_needs.output.regs[j][i] += out_max;
                  insn_needs.other.regs[j][i]
                  += MAX (MAX (insn_needs.input.regs[j][i],
                             insn_needs.output.regs[j][i]),
                        insn_needs.other_addr.regs[j][i]);

                }

              /* Now compute group needs.  */
              for (in_max = 0, out_max = 0, j = 0;
                   j < reload_n_operands; j++)
                {
                  in_max = MAX (in_max, insn_needs.in_addr[j].groups[i]);
                  in_max = MAX (in_max,
                             insn_needs.in_addr_addr[j].groups[i]);
                  out_max
                  = MAX (out_max, insn_needs.out_addr[j].groups[i]);
                  out_max
                  = MAX (out_max, insn_needs.out_addr_addr[j].groups[i]);
                }

              in_max = MAX (MAX (insn_needs.op_addr.groups[i],
                             insn_needs.op_addr_reload.groups[i]),
                        in_max);
              out_max = MAX (out_max, insn_needs.insn.groups[i]);

              insn_needs.input.groups[i]
                = MAX (insn_needs.input.groups[i]
                     + insn_needs.op_addr.groups[i]
                     + insn_needs.insn.groups[i],
                     in_max + insn_needs.input.groups[i]);

              insn_needs.output.groups[i] += out_max;
              insn_needs.other.groups[i]
                += MAX (MAX (insn_needs.input.groups[i],
                         insn_needs.output.groups[i]),
                      insn_needs.other_addr.groups[i]);
            }

            /* If this is a CALL_INSN and caller-saves will need
             a spill register, act as if the spill register is
             needed for this insn.   However, the spill register
             can be used by any reload of this insn, so we only
             need do something if no need for that class has
             been recorded.

             The assumption that every CALL_INSN will trigger a
             caller-save is highly conservative, however, the number
             of cases where caller-saves will need a spill register but
             a block containing a CALL_INSN won't need a spill register
             of that class should be quite rare.

             If a group is needed, the size and mode of the group will
             have been set up at the beginning of this loop.  */

            if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN
              && caller_save_spill_class != NO_REGS)
            {
              /* See if this register would conflict with any reload that
                 needs a group or any reload that needs a nongroup.  */
              int nongroup_need = 0;
              int *caller_save_needs;

              for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
                if (reg_classes_intersect_p (caller_save_spill_class,
                                     reload_reg_class[j])
                  && ((CLASS_MAX_NREGS
                       (reload_reg_class[j],
                        (GET_MODE_SIZE (reload_outmode[j])
                         > GET_MODE_SIZE (reload_inmode[j]))
                        ? reload_outmode[j] : reload_inmode[j])
                       > 1)
                      || reload_nongroup[j]))
                  {
                  nongroup_need = 1;
                  break;
                  }

              caller_save_needs 
                = (caller_save_group_size > 1
                   ? insn_needs.other.groups
                   : insn_needs.other.regs[nongroup_need]); 

              if (caller_save_needs[(int) caller_save_spill_class] == 0)
                {
                  register enum reg_class *p
                  = reg_class_superclasses[(int) caller_save_spill_class];

                  caller_save_needs[(int) caller_save_spill_class]++;

                  while (*p != LIM_REG_CLASSES)
                  caller_save_needs[(int) *p++] += 1;
                }

              /* Show that this basic block will need a register of
                   this class.  */

              if (global
                  && ! (basic_block_needs[(int) caller_save_spill_class]
                      [this_block]))
                {
                  basic_block_needs[(int) caller_save_spill_class]
                  [this_block] = 1;
                  new_basic_block_needs = 1;
                }
            }

            /* If this insn stores the value of a function call,
             and that value is in a register that has been spilled,
             and if the insn needs a reload in a class
             that might use that register as the reload register,
             then add an extra need in that class.
             This makes sure we have a register available that does
             not overlap the return value.  */

            if (SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES && avoid_return_reg)
            {
              int regno = REGNO (avoid_return_reg);
              int nregs
                = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, GET_MODE (avoid_return_reg));
              int r;
              int basic_needs[N_REG_CLASSES], basic_groups[N_REG_CLASSES];

              /* First compute the "basic needs", which counts a
                 need only in the smallest class in which it
                 is required.  */

              bcopy ((char *) insn_needs.other.regs[0],
                   (char *) basic_needs, sizeof basic_needs);
              bcopy ((char *) insn_needs.other.groups,
                   (char *) basic_groups, sizeof basic_groups);

              for (i = 0; i < N_REG_CLASSES; i++)
                {
                  enum reg_class *p;

                  if (basic_needs[i] >= 0)
                  for (p = reg_class_superclasses[i];
                       *p != LIM_REG_CLASSES; p++)
                    basic_needs[(int) *p] -= basic_needs[i];

                  if (basic_groups[i] >= 0)
                  for (p = reg_class_superclasses[i];
                       *p != LIM_REG_CLASSES; p++)
                    basic_groups[(int) *p] -= basic_groups[i];
                }

              /* Now count extra regs if there might be a conflict with
                 the return value register.  */

              for (r = regno; r < regno + nregs; r++)
                if (spill_reg_order[r] >= 0)
                  for (i = 0; i < N_REG_CLASSES; i++)
                  if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[i], r))
                    {
                      if (basic_needs[i] > 0)
                        {
                        enum reg_class *p;

                        insn_needs.other.regs[0][i]++;
                        p = reg_class_superclasses[i];
                        while (*p != LIM_REG_CLASSES)
                          insn_needs.other.regs[0][(int) *p++]++;
                        }
                      if (basic_groups[i] > 0)
                        {
                        enum reg_class *p;

                        insn_needs.other.groups[i]++;
                        p = reg_class_superclasses[i];
                        while (*p != LIM_REG_CLASSES)
                          insn_needs.other.groups[(int) *p++]++;
                        }
                    }
            }

            /* For each class, collect maximum need of any insn.  */

            for (i = 0; i < N_REG_CLASSES; i++)
            {
              if (max_needs[i] < insn_needs.other.regs[0][i])
                {
                  max_needs[i] = insn_needs.other.regs[0][i];
                  max_needs_insn[i] = insn;
                }
              if (max_groups[i] < insn_needs.other.groups[i])
                {
                  max_groups[i] = insn_needs.other.groups[i];
                  max_groups_insn[i] = insn;
                }
              if (max_nongroups[i] < insn_needs.other.regs[1][i])
                {
                  max_nongroups[i] = insn_needs.other.regs[1][i];
                  max_nongroups_insn[i] = insn;
                }
            }
          }
        /* Note that there is a continue statement above.  */
      }

      /* If we allocated any new memory locations, make another pass
       since it might have changed elimination offsets.  */
      if (starting_frame_size != get_frame_size ())
      something_changed = 1;

      if (dumpfile)
      for (i = 0; i < N_REG_CLASSES; i++)
        {
          if (max_needs[i] > 0)
            fprintf (dumpfile,
                   ";; Need %d reg%s of class %s (for insn %d).\n",
                   max_needs[i], max_needs[i] == 1 ? "" : "s",
                   reg_class_names[i], INSN_UID (max_needs_insn[i]));
          if (max_nongroups[i] > 0)
            fprintf (dumpfile,
                   ";; Need %d nongroup reg%s of class %s (for insn %d).\n",
                   max_nongroups[i], max_nongroups[i] == 1 ? "" : "s",
                   reg_class_names[i], INSN_UID (max_nongroups_insn[i]));
          if (max_groups[i] > 0)
            fprintf (dumpfile,
                   ";; Need %d group%s (%smode) of class %s (for insn %d).\n",
                   max_groups[i], max_groups[i] == 1 ? "" : "s",
                   mode_name[(int) group_mode[i]],
                   reg_class_names[i], INSN_UID (max_groups_insn[i]));
        }
                   
      /* If we have caller-saves, set up the save areas and see if caller-save
       will need a spill register.  */

      if (caller_save_needed)
      {
        /* Set the offsets for setup_save_areas.  */
        for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
             ep++)
          ep->previous_offset = ep->max_offset;

        if ( ! setup_save_areas (&something_changed)
            && caller_save_spill_class  == NO_REGS)
          {
            /* The class we will need depends on whether the machine
             supports the sum of two registers for an address; see
            find_address_reloads for details.  */

            caller_save_spill_class
            = double_reg_address_ok ? INDEX_REG_CLASS : BASE_REG_CLASS;
            caller_save_group_size
            = CLASS_MAX_NREGS (caller_save_spill_class, Pmode);
            something_changed = 1;
          }
      }

      /* See if anything that happened changes which eliminations are valid.
       For example, on the Sparc, whether or not the frame pointer can
       be eliminated can depend on what registers have been used.  We need
       not check some conditions again (such as flag_omit_frame_pointer)
       since they can't have changed.  */

      for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
      if ((ep->from == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED)
#ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
          || ! CAN_ELIMINATE (ep->from, ep->to)
#endif
          )
        ep->can_eliminate = 0;

      /* Look for the case where we have discovered that we can't replace
       register A with register B and that means that we will now be
       trying to replace register A with register C.  This means we can
       no longer replace register C with register B and we need to disable
       such an elimination, if it exists.  This occurs often with A == ap,
       B == sp, and C == fp.  */

      for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
      {
        struct elim_table *op;
        register int new_to = -1;

        if (! ep->can_eliminate && ep->can_eliminate_previous)
          {
            /* Find the current elimination for ep->from, if there is a
             new one.  */
            for (op = reg_eliminate;
               op < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; op++)
            if (op->from == ep->from && op->can_eliminate)
              {
                new_to = op->to;
                break;
              }

            /* See if there is an elimination of NEW_TO -> EP->TO.  If so,
             disable it.  */
            for (op = reg_eliminate;
               op < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; op++)
            if (op->from == new_to && op->to == ep->to)
              op->can_eliminate = 0;
          }
      }

      /* See if any registers that we thought we could eliminate the previous
       time are no longer eliminable.  If so, something has changed and we
       must spill the register.  Also, recompute the number of eliminable
       registers and see if the frame pointer is needed; it is if there is
       no elimination of the frame pointer that we can perform.  */

      frame_pointer_needed = 1;
      for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
      {
        if (ep->can_eliminate && ep->from == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
            && ep->to != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
          frame_pointer_needed = 0;

        if (! ep->can_eliminate && ep->can_eliminate_previous)
          {
            ep->can_eliminate_previous = 0;
            spill_hard_reg (ep->from, global, dumpfile, 1);
            something_changed = 1;
            num_eliminable--;
          }
      }

#if HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
      /* If we didn't need a frame pointer last time, but we do now, spill
       the hard frame pointer.  */
      if (frame_pointer_needed && ! previous_frame_pointer_needed)
      {
        spill_hard_reg (HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, global, dumpfile, 1);
        something_changed = 1;
      }
#endif

      /* If all needs are met, we win.  */

      for (i = 0; i < N_REG_CLASSES; i++)
      if (max_needs[i] > 0 || max_groups[i] > 0 || max_nongroups[i] > 0)
        break;
      if (i == N_REG_CLASSES && !new_basic_block_needs && ! something_changed)
      break;

      /* Not all needs are met; must spill some hard regs.  */

      /* Put all registers spilled so far back in potential_reload_regs, but
       put them at the front, since we've already spilled most of the
       pseudos in them (we might have left some pseudos unspilled if they
       were in a block that didn't need any spill registers of a conflicting
       class.  We used to try to mark off the need for those registers,
       but doing so properly is very complex and reallocating them is the
       simpler approach.  First, "pack" potential_reload_regs by pushing 
       any nonnegative entries towards the end.  That will leave room 
       for the registers we already spilled.

       Also, undo the marking of the spill registers from the last time
       around in FORBIDDEN_REGS since we will be probably be allocating
       them again below.

       ??? It is theoretically possible that we might end up not using one
       of our previously-spilled registers in this allocation, even though
       they are at the head of the list.  It's not clear what to do about
       this, but it was no better before, when we marked off the needs met
       by the previously-spilled registers.  With the current code, globals
       can be allocated into these registers, but locals cannot.  */

      if (n_spills)
      {
        for (i = j = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER - 1; i >= 0; i--)
          if (potential_reload_regs[i] != -1)
            potential_reload_regs[j--] = potential_reload_regs[i];

        for (i = 0; i < n_spills; i++)
          {
            potential_reload_regs[i] = spill_regs[i];
            spill_reg_order[spill_regs[i]] = -1;
            CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (forbidden_regs, spill_regs[i]);
          }

        n_spills = 0;
      }

      /* Now find more reload regs to satisfy the remaining need
       Do it by ascending class number, since otherwise a reg
       might be spilled for a big class and might fail to count
       for a smaller class even though it belongs to that class.

       Count spilled regs in `spills', and add entries to
       `spill_regs' and `spill_reg_order'.

       ??? Note there is a problem here.
       When there is a need for a group in a high-numbered class,
       and also need for non-group regs that come from a lower class,
       the non-group regs are chosen first.  If there aren't many regs,
       they might leave no room for a group.

       This was happening on the 386.  To fix it, we added the code
       that calls possible_group_p, so that the lower class won't
       break up the last possible group.

       Really fixing the problem would require changes above
       in counting the regs already spilled, and in choose_reload_regs.
       It might be hard to avoid introducing bugs there.  */

      CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (counted_for_groups);
      CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (counted_for_nongroups);

      for (class = 0; class < N_REG_CLASSES; class++)
      {
        /* First get the groups of registers.
           If we got single registers first, we might fragment
           possible groups.  */
        while (max_groups[class] > 0)
          {
            /* If any single spilled regs happen to form groups,
             count them now.  Maybe we don't really need
             to spill another group.  */
            count_possible_groups (group_size, group_mode, max_groups,
                             class);

            if (max_groups[class] <= 0)
            break;

            /* Groups of size 2 (the only groups used on most machines)
             are treated specially.  */
            if (group_size[class] == 2)
            {
              /* First, look for a register that will complete a group.  */
              for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
                {
                  int other;

                  j = potential_reload_regs[i];
                  if (j >= 0 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (bad_spill_regs, j)
                    &&
                    ((j > 0 && (other = j - 1, spill_reg_order[other] >= 0)
                      && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[class], j)
                      && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[class], other)
                      && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (other, group_mode[class])
                      && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (counted_for_nongroups,
                                        other)
                      /* We don't want one part of another group.
                         We could get "two groups" that overlap!  */
                      && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (counted_for_groups, other))
                     ||
                     (j < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER - 1
                      && (other = j + 1, spill_reg_order[other] >= 0)
                      && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[class], j)
                      && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[class], other)
                      && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (j, group_mode[class])
                      && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (counted_for_nongroups,
                                        other)
                      && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (counted_for_groups,
                                        other))))
                  {
                    register enum reg_class *p;

                    /* We have found one that will complete a group,
                       so count off one group as provided.  */
                    max_groups[class]--;
                    p = reg_class_superclasses[class];
                    while (*p != LIM_REG_CLASSES)
                      {
                        if (group_size [(int) *p] <= group_size [class])
                        max_groups[(int) *p]--;
                        p++;
                      }

                    /* Indicate both these regs are part of a group.  */
                    SET_HARD_REG_BIT (counted_for_groups, j);
                    SET_HARD_REG_BIT (counted_for_groups, other);
                    break;
                  }
                }
              /* We can't complete a group, so start one.  */
              /* Look for a pair neither of which is explicitly used.  */
              if (SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES && i == FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
                for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
                  {
                  int k;
                  j = potential_reload_regs[i];
                  /* Verify that J+1 is a potential reload reg.  */
                  for (k = 0; k < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; k++)
                    if (potential_reload_regs[k] == j + 1)
                      break;
                  if (j >= 0 && j + 1 < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
                      && k < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
                      && spill_reg_order[j] < 0 && spill_reg_order[j + 1] < 0
                      && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[class], j)
                      && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[class], j + 1)
                      && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (j, group_mode[class])
                      && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (counted_for_nongroups,
                                        j + 1)
                      && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (bad_spill_regs, j + 1)
                      /* Reject J at this stage
                         if J+1 was explicitly used.  */
                      && ! regs_explicitly_used[j + 1])
                    break;
                  }
              /* Now try any group at all
                 whose registers are not in bad_spill_regs.  */
              if (i == FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
                for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
                  {
                  int k;
                  j = potential_reload_regs[i];
                  /* Verify that J+1 is a potential reload reg.  */
                  for (k = 0; k < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; k++)
                    if (potential_reload_regs[k] == j + 1)
                      break;
                  if (j >= 0 && j + 1 < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
                      && k < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
                      && spill_reg_order[j] < 0 && spill_reg_order[j + 1] < 0
                      && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[class], j)
                      && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[class], j + 1)
                      && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (j, group_mode[class])
                      && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (counted_for_nongroups,
                                        j + 1)
                      && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (bad_spill_regs, j + 1))
                    break;
                  }

              /* I should be the index in potential_reload_regs
                 of the new reload reg we have found.  */

              if (i >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
                {
                  /* There are no groups left to spill.  */
                  spill_failure (max_groups_insn[class]);
                  failure = 1;
                  goto failed;
                }
              else
                something_changed
                  |= new_spill_reg (i, class, max_needs, NULL_PTR,
                              global, dumpfile);
            }
            else
            {
              /* For groups of more than 2 registers,
                 look for a sufficient sequence of unspilled registers,
                 and spill them all at once.  */
              for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
                {
                  int k;

                  j = potential_reload_regs[i];
                  if (j >= 0
                    && j + group_size[class] <= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
                    && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (j, group_mode[class]))
                  {
                    /* Check each reg in the sequence.  */
                    for (k = 0; k < group_size[class]; k++)
                      if (! (spill_reg_order[j + k] < 0
                           && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (bad_spill_regs, j + k)
                           && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[class], j + k)))
                        break;
                    /* We got a full sequence, so spill them all.  */
                    if (k == group_size[class])
                      {
                        register enum reg_class *p;
                        for (k = 0; k < group_size[class]; k++)
                        {
                          int idx;
                          SET_HARD_REG_BIT (counted_for_groups, j + k);
                          for (idx = 0; idx < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; idx++)
                            if (potential_reload_regs[idx] == j + k)
                              break;
                          something_changed
                            |= new_spill_reg (idx, class,
                                          max_needs, NULL_PTR,
                                          global, dumpfile);
                        }

                        /* We have found one that will complete a group,
                         so count off one group as provided.  */
                        max_groups[class]--;
                        p = reg_class_superclasses[class];
                        while (*p != LIM_REG_CLASSES)
                        {
                          if (group_size [(int) *p]
                              <= group_size [class])
                            max_groups[(int) *p]--;
                          p++;
                        }
                        break;
                      }
                  }
                }
              /* We couldn't find any registers for this reload.
                 Avoid going into an infinite loop.  */
              if (i >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
                {
                  /* There are no groups left.  */
                  spill_failure (max_groups_insn[class]);
                  failure = 1;
                  goto failed;
                }
            }
          }

        /* Now similarly satisfy all need for single registers.  */

        while (max_needs[class] > 0 || max_nongroups[class] > 0)
          {
            /* If we spilled enough regs, but they weren't counted
             against the non-group need, see if we can count them now.
             If so, we can avoid some actual spilling.  */
            if (max_needs[class] <= 0 && max_nongroups[class] > 0)
            for (i = 0; i < n_spills; i++)
              if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[class],
                               spill_regs[i])
                  && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (counted_for_groups,
                                   spill_regs[i])
                  && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (counted_for_nongroups,
                                   spill_regs[i])
                  && max_nongroups[class] > 0)
                {
                  register enum reg_class *p;

                  SET_HARD_REG_BIT (counted_for_nongroups, spill_regs[i]);
                  max_nongroups[class]--;
                  p = reg_class_superclasses[class];
                  while (*p != LIM_REG_CLASSES)
                  max_nongroups[(int) *p++]--;
                }
            if (max_needs[class] <= 0 && max_nongroups[class] <= 0)
            break;

            /* Consider the potential reload regs that aren't
             yet in use as reload regs, in order of preference.
             Find the most preferred one that's in this class.  */

            for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
            if (potential_reload_regs[i] >= 0
                && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[class],
                                potential_reload_regs[i])
                /* If this reg will not be available for groups,
                   pick one that does not foreclose possible groups.
                   This is a kludge, and not very general,
                   but it should be sufficient to make the 386 work,
                   and the problem should not occur on machines with
                   more registers.  */
                && (max_nongroups[class] == 0
                  || possible_group_p (potential_reload_regs[i], max_groups)))
              break;

            /* If we couldn't get a register, try to get one even if we
             might foreclose possible groups.  This may cause problems
             later, but that's better than aborting now, since it is
             possible that we will, in fact, be able to form the needed
             group even with this allocation.  */

            if (i >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
              && (asm_noperands (max_needs[class] > 0
                             ? max_needs_insn[class]
                             : max_nongroups_insn[class])
                  < 0))
            for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
              if (potential_reload_regs[i] >= 0
                  && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[class],
                                  potential_reload_regs[i]))
                break;

            /* I should be the index in potential_reload_regs
             of the new reload reg we have found.  */

            if (i >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
            {
              /* There are no possible registers left to spill.  */
              spill_failure (max_needs[class] > 0 ? max_needs_insn[class]
                         : max_nongroups_insn[class]);
              failure = 1;
              goto failed;
            }
            else
            something_changed
              |= new_spill_reg (i, class, max_needs, max_nongroups,
                            global, dumpfile);
          }
      }
    }

  /* If global-alloc was run, notify it of any register eliminations we have
     done.  */
  if (global)
    for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
      if (ep->can_eliminate)
      mark_elimination (ep->from, ep->to);

  /* Insert code to save and restore call-clobbered hard regs
     around calls.  Tell if what mode to use so that we will process
     those insns in reload_as_needed if we have to.  */

  if (caller_save_needed)
    save_call_clobbered_regs (num_eliminable ? QImode
                        : caller_save_spill_class != NO_REGS ? HImode
                        : VOIDmode);

  /* If a pseudo has no hard reg, delete the insns that made the equivalence.
     If that insn didn't set the register (i.e., it copied the register to
     memory), just delete that insn instead of the equivalencing insn plus
     anything now dead.  If we call delete_dead_insn on that insn, we may
     delete the insn that actually sets the register if the register die
     there and that is incorrect.  */

  for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
    if (reg_renumber[i] < 0 && reg_equiv_init[i] != 0
      && GET_CODE (reg_equiv_init[i]) != NOTE)
      {
      if (reg_set_p (regno_reg_rtx[i], PATTERN (reg_equiv_init[i])))
        delete_dead_insn (reg_equiv_init[i]);
      else
        {
          PUT_CODE (reg_equiv_init[i], NOTE);
          NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (reg_equiv_init[i]) = 0;
          NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (reg_equiv_init[i]) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
        }
      }

  /* Use the reload registers where necessary
     by generating move instructions to move the must-be-register
     values into or out of the reload registers.  */

  if (something_needs_reloads || something_needs_elimination
      || (caller_save_needed && num_eliminable)
      || caller_save_spill_class != NO_REGS)
    reload_as_needed (first, global);

  /* If we were able to eliminate the frame pointer, show that it is no
     longer live at the start of any basic block.  If it ls live by
     virtue of being in a pseudo, that pseudo will be marked live
     and hence the frame pointer will be known to be live via that
     pseudo.  */

  if (! frame_pointer_needed)
    for (i = 0; i < n_basic_blocks; i++)
      CLEAR_REGNO_REG_SET (basic_block_live_at_start[i],
                     HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);

  /* Come here (with failure set nonzero) if we can't get enough spill regs
     and we decide not to abort about it.  */
 failed:

  reload_in_progress = 0;

  /* Now eliminate all pseudo regs by modifying them into
     their equivalent memory references.
     The REG-rtx's for the pseudos are modified in place,
     so all insns that used to refer to them now refer to memory.

     For a reg that has a reg_equiv_address, all those insns
     were changed by reloading so that no insns refer to it any longer;
     but the DECL_RTL of a variable decl may refer to it,
     and if so this causes the debugging info to mention the variable.  */

  for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
    {
      rtx addr = 0;
      int in_struct = 0;
      int is_readonly = 0;

      if (reg_equiv_memory_loc[i])
      {
        in_struct = MEM_IN_STRUCT_P (reg_equiv_memory_loc[i]);
        is_readonly = RTX_UNCHANGING_P (reg_equiv_memory_loc[i]);
      }

      if (reg_equiv_mem[i])
      addr = XEXP (reg_equiv_mem[i], 0);

      if (reg_equiv_address[i])
      addr = reg_equiv_address[i];

      if (addr)
      {
        if (reg_renumber[i] < 0)
          {
            rtx reg = regno_reg_rtx[i];
            XEXP (reg, 0) = addr;
            REG_USERVAR_P (reg) = 0;
            RTX_UNCHANGING_P (reg) = is_readonly;
            MEM_IN_STRUCT_P (reg) = in_struct;
            /* We have no alias information about this newly created
             MEM.  */
            MEM_ALIAS_SET (reg) = 0;
            PUT_CODE (reg, MEM);
          }
        else if (reg_equiv_mem[i])
          XEXP (reg_equiv_mem[i], 0) = addr;
      }
    }

  /* Make a pass over all the insns and delete all USEs which we inserted
     only to tag a REG_EQUAL note on them; if PRESERVE_DEATH_INFO_REGNO_P
     is defined, also remove death notes for things that are no longer
     registers or no longer die in the insn (e.g., an input and output
     pseudo being tied).  */

  for (insn = first; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
    if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (insn)) == 'i')
      {
#ifdef PRESERVE_DEATH_INFO_REGNO_P
      rtx note, next;
#endif

      if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE
          && find_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUAL, NULL_RTX))
        {
          PUT_CODE (insn, NOTE);
          NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (insn) = 0;
          NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
          continue;
        }
#ifdef PRESERVE_DEATH_INFO_REGNO_P
      for (note = REG_NOTES (insn); note; note = next)
        {
          next = XEXP (note, 1);
          if (REG_NOTE_KIND (note) == REG_DEAD
            && (GET_CODE (XEXP (note, 0)) != REG
                || reg_set_p (XEXP (note, 0), PATTERN (insn))))
            remove_note (insn, note);
        }
#endif
      }

  /* If we are doing stack checking, give a warning if this function's
     frame size is larger than we expect.  */
  if (flag_stack_check && ! STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN)
    {
      HOST_WIDE_INT size = get_frame_size () + STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE;

      for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
      if (regs_ever_live[i] && ! fixed_regs[i] && call_used_regs[i])
        size += UNITS_PER_WORD;

      if (size > STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE)
      warning ("frame size too large for reliable stack checking");
    }
      
  /* Indicate that we no longer have known memory locations or constants.  */
  reg_equiv_constant = 0;
  reg_equiv_memory_loc = 0;

  if (real_known_ptr)
    free (real_known_ptr);
  if (real_at_ptr)
    free (real_at_ptr);

  if (scratch_list)
    free (scratch_list);
  scratch_list = 0;
  if (scratch_block)
    free (scratch_block);
  scratch_block = 0;

  CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs);
  for (i = 0; i < n_spills; i++)
    SET_HARD_REG_BIT (used_spill_regs, spill_regs[i]);

  return failure;
}

/* Nonzero if, after spilling reg REGNO for non-groups,
   it will still be possible to find a group if we still need one.  */

static int
possible_group_p (regno, max_groups)
     int regno;
     int *max_groups;
{
  int i;
  int class = (int) NO_REGS;

  for (i = 0; i < (int) N_REG_CLASSES; i++)
    if (max_groups[i] > 0)
      {
      class = i;
      break;
      }

  if (class == (int) NO_REGS)
    return 1;

  /* Consider each pair of consecutive registers.  */
  for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER - 1; i++)
    {
      /* Ignore pairs that include reg REGNO.  */
      if (i == regno || i + 1 == regno)
      continue;

      /* Ignore pairs that are outside the class that needs the group.
       ??? Here we fail to handle the case where two different classes
       independently need groups.  But this never happens with our
       current machine descriptions.  */
      if (! (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[class], i)
           && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[class], i + 1)))
      continue;

      /* A pair of consecutive regs we can still spill does the trick.  */
      if (spill_reg_order[i] < 0 && spill_reg_order[i + 1] < 0
        && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (bad_spill_regs, i)
        && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (bad_spill_regs, i + 1))
      return 1;

      /* A pair of one already spilled and one we can spill does it
       provided the one already spilled is not otherwise reserved.  */
      if (spill_reg_order[i] < 0
        && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (bad_spill_regs, i)
        && spill_reg_order[i + 1] >= 0
        && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (counted_for_groups, i + 1)
        && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (counted_for_nongroups, i + 1))
      return 1;
      if (spill_reg_order[i + 1] < 0
        && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (bad_spill_regs, i + 1)
        && spill_reg_order[i] >= 0
        && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (counted_for_groups, i)
        && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (counted_for_nongroups, i))
      return 1;
    }

  return 0;
}

/* Count any groups of CLASS that can be formed from the registers recently
   spilled.  */

static void
count_possible_groups (group_size, group_mode, max_groups, class)
     int *group_size;
     enum machine_mode *group_mode;
     int *max_groups;
     int class;
{
  HARD_REG_SET new;
  int i, j;

  /* Now find all consecutive groups of spilled registers
     and mark each group off against the need for such groups.
     But don't count them against ordinary need, yet.  */

  if (group_size[class] == 0)
    return;

  CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (new);

  /* Make a mask of all the regs that are spill regs in class I.  */
  for (i = 0; i < n_spills; i++)
    if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[class], spill_regs[i])
      && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (counted_for_groups, spill_regs[i])
      && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (counted_for_nongroups, spill_regs[i]))
      SET_HARD_REG_BIT (new, spill_regs[i]);

  /* Find each consecutive group of them.  */
  for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER && max_groups[class] > 0; i++)
    if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (new, i)
      && i + group_size[class] <= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
      && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (i, group_mode[class]))
      {
      for (j = 1; j < group_size[class]; j++)
        if (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (new, i + j))
          break;

      if (j == group_size[class])
        {
          /* We found a group.  Mark it off against this class's need for
             groups, and against each superclass too.  */
          register enum reg_class *p;

          max_groups[class]--;
          p = reg_class_superclasses[class];
          while (*p != LIM_REG_CLASSES)
            {
            if (group_size [(int) *p] <= group_size [class])
              max_groups[(int) *p]--;
            p++;
            }

          /* Don't count these registers again.  */
          for (j = 0; j < group_size[class]; j++)
            SET_HARD_REG_BIT (counted_for_groups, i + j);
        }

      /* Skip to the last reg in this group.  When i is incremented above,
         it will then point to the first reg of the next possible group.  */
      i += j - 1;
      }
}

/* ALLOCATE_MODE is a register mode that needs to be reloaded.  OTHER_MODE is
   another mode that needs to be reloaded for the same register class CLASS.
   If any reg in CLASS allows ALLOCATE_MODE but not OTHER_MODE, fail.
   ALLOCATE_MODE will never be smaller than OTHER_MODE.

   This code used to also fail if any reg in CLASS allows OTHER_MODE but not
   ALLOCATE_MODE.  This test is unnecessary, because we will never try to put
   something of mode ALLOCATE_MODE into an OTHER_MODE register.  Testing this
   causes unnecessary failures on machines requiring alignment of register
   groups when the two modes are different sizes, because the larger mode has
   more strict alignment rules than the smaller mode.  */

static int
modes_equiv_for_class_p (allocate_mode, other_mode, class)
     enum machine_mode allocate_mode, other_mode;
     enum reg_class class;
{
  register int regno;
  for (regno = 0; regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; regno++)
    {
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) class], regno)
        && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, allocate_mode)
        && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, other_mode))
      return 0;
    }
  return 1;
}

/* Handle the failure to find a register to spill.
   INSN should be one of the insns which needed this particular spill reg.  */

static void
spill_failure (insn)
     rtx insn;
{
  if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) >= 0)
    error_for_asm (insn, "`asm' needs too many reloads");
  else
    fatal_insn ("Unable to find a register to spill.", insn);
}

/* Add a new register to the tables of available spill-registers
    (as well as spilling all pseudos allocated to the register).
   I is the index of this register in potential_reload_regs.
   CLASS is the regclass whose need is being satisfied.
   MAX_NEEDS and MAX_NONGROUPS are the vectors of needs,
    so that this register can count off against them.
    MAX_NONGROUPS is 0 if this register is part of a group.
   GLOBAL and DUMPFILE are the same as the args that `reload' got.  */

static int
new_spill_reg (i, class, max_needs, max_nongroups, global, dumpfile)
     int i;
     int class;
     int *max_needs;
     int *max_nongroups;
     int global;
     FILE *dumpfile;
{
  register enum reg_class *p;
  int val;
  int regno = potential_reload_regs[i];

  if (i >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
    abort ();     /* Caller failed to find any register.  */

  if (fixed_regs[regno] || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (forbidden_regs, regno))
    {
      static char *reg_class_names[] = REG_CLASS_NAMES;
      fatal ("fixed or forbidden register %d (%s) was spilled for class %s.\n\
This may be due to a compiler bug or to impossible asm\n\
statements or clauses.", regno, reg_names[regno], reg_class_names[class]);
    }

  /* Make reg REGNO an additional reload reg.  */

  potential_reload_regs[i] = -1;
  spill_regs[n_spills] = regno;
  spill_reg_order[regno] = n_spills;
  if (dumpfile)
    fprintf (dumpfile, "Spilling reg %d.\n", spill_regs[n_spills]);

  /* Clear off the needs we just satisfied.  */

  max_needs[class]--;
  p = reg_class_superclasses[class];
  while (*p != LIM_REG_CLASSES)
    max_needs[(int) *p++]--;

  if (max_nongroups && max_nongroups[class] > 0)
    {
      SET_HARD_REG_BIT (counted_for_nongroups, regno);
      max_nongroups[class]--;
      p = reg_class_superclasses[class];
      while (*p != LIM_REG_CLASSES)
      max_nongroups[(int) *p++]--;
    }

  /* Spill every pseudo reg that was allocated to this reg
     or to something that overlaps this reg.  */

  val = spill_hard_reg (spill_regs[n_spills], global, dumpfile, 0);

  /* If there are some registers still to eliminate and this register
     wasn't ever used before, additional stack space may have to be
     allocated to store this register.  Thus, we may have changed the offset
     between the stack and frame pointers, so mark that something has changed.
     (If new pseudos were spilled, thus requiring more space, VAL would have
     been set non-zero by the call to spill_hard_reg above since additional
     reloads may be needed in that case.

     One might think that we need only set VAL to 1 if this is a call-used
     register.  However, the set of registers that must be saved by the
     prologue is not identical to the call-used set.  For example, the
     register used by the call insn for the return PC is a call-used register,
     but must be saved by the prologue.  */
  if (num_eliminable && ! regs_ever_live[spill_regs[n_spills]])
    val = 1;

  regs_ever_live[spill_regs[n_spills]] = 1;
  n_spills++;

  return val;
}

/* Delete an unneeded INSN and any previous insns who sole purpose is loading
   data that is dead in INSN.  */

static void
delete_dead_insn (insn)
     rtx insn;
{
  rtx prev = prev_real_insn (insn);
  rtx prev_dest;

  /* If the previous insn sets a register that dies in our insn, delete it
     too.  */
  if (prev && GET_CODE (PATTERN (prev)) == SET
      && (prev_dest = SET_DEST (PATTERN (prev)), GET_CODE (prev_dest) == REG)
      && reg_mentioned_p (prev_dest, PATTERN (insn))
      && find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, REGNO (prev_dest))
      && ! side_effects_p (SET_SRC (PATTERN (prev))))
    delete_dead_insn (prev);

  PUT_CODE (insn, NOTE);
  NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
  NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (insn) = 0;
}

/* Modify the home of pseudo-reg I.
   The new home is present in reg_renumber[I].

   FROM_REG may be the hard reg that the pseudo-reg is being spilled from;
   or it may be -1, meaning there is none or it is not relevant.
   This is used so that all pseudos spilled from a given hard reg
   can share one stack slot.  */

static void
alter_reg (i, from_reg)
     register int i;
     int from_reg;
{
  /* When outputting an inline function, this can happen
     for a reg that isn't actually used.  */
  if (regno_reg_rtx[i] == 0)
    return;

  /* If the reg got changed to a MEM at rtl-generation time,
     ignore it.  */
  if (GET_CODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]) != REG)
    return;

  /* Modify the reg-rtx to contain the new hard reg
     number or else to contain its pseudo reg number.  */
  REGNO (regno_reg_rtx[i])
    = reg_renumber[i] >= 0 ? reg_renumber[i] : i;

  /* If we have a pseudo that is needed but has no hard reg or equivalent,
     allocate a stack slot for it.  */

  if (reg_renumber[i] < 0
      && REG_N_REFS (i) > 0
      && reg_equiv_constant[i] == 0
      && reg_equiv_memory_loc[i] == 0)
    {
      register rtx x;
      int inherent_size = PSEUDO_REGNO_BYTES (i);
      int total_size = MAX (inherent_size, reg_max_ref_width[i]);
      int adjust = 0;

      /* Each pseudo reg has an inherent size which comes from its own mode,
       and a total size which provides room for paradoxical subregs
       which refer to the pseudo reg in wider modes.

       We can use a slot already allocated if it provides both
       enough inherent space and enough total space.
       Otherwise, we allocate a new slot, making sure that it has no less
       inherent space, and no less total space, then the previous slot.  */
      if (from_reg == -1)
      {
        /* No known place to spill from => no slot to reuse.  */
        x = assign_stack_local (GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]), total_size,
                          inherent_size == total_size ? 0 : -1);
        if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
          /* Cancel the  big-endian correction done in assign_stack_local.
             Get the address of the beginning of the slot.
             This is so we can do a big-endian correction unconditionally
             below.  */
          adjust = inherent_size - total_size;

        RTX_UNCHANGING_P (x) = RTX_UNCHANGING_P (regno_reg_rtx[i]);
      }
      /* Reuse a stack slot if possible.  */
      else if (spill_stack_slot[from_reg] != 0
             && spill_stack_slot_width[from_reg] >= total_size
             && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]))
               >= inherent_size))
      x = spill_stack_slot[from_reg];
      /* Allocate a bigger slot.  */
      else
      {
        /* Compute maximum size needed, both for inherent size
           and for total size.  */
        enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]);
        rtx stack_slot;
        if (spill_stack_slot[from_reg])
          {
            if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]))
              > inherent_size)
            mode = GET_MODE (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]);
            if (spill_stack_slot_width[from_reg] > total_size)
            total_size = spill_stack_slot_width[from_reg];
          }
        /* Make a slot with that size.  */
        x = assign_stack_local (mode, total_size,
                          inherent_size == total_size ? 0 : -1);
        stack_slot = x;
        if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
          {
            /* Cancel the  big-endian correction done in assign_stack_local.
             Get the address of the beginning of the slot.
             This is so we can do a big-endian correction unconditionally
             below.  */
            adjust = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - total_size;
            if (adjust)
            stack_slot = gen_rtx_MEM (mode_for_size (total_size
                                           * BITS_PER_UNIT,
                                           MODE_INT, 1),
                              plus_constant (XEXP (x, 0), adjust));
          }
        spill_stack_slot[from_reg] = stack_slot;
        spill_stack_slot_width[from_reg] = total_size;
      }

      /* On a big endian machine, the "address" of the slot
       is the address of the low part that fits its inherent mode.  */
      if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN && inherent_size < total_size)
      adjust += (total_size - inherent_size);

      /* If we have any adjustment to make, or if the stack slot is the
       wrong mode, make a new stack slot.  */
      if (adjust != 0 || GET_MODE (x) != GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]))
      {
        x = gen_rtx_MEM (GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]),
                   plus_constant (XEXP (x, 0), adjust));

        /* If this was shared among registers, must ensure we never
           set it readonly since that can cause scheduling
           problems.  Note we would only have in this adjustment
           case in any event, since the code above doesn't set it.  */

        if (from_reg == -1)
          RTX_UNCHANGING_P (x) = RTX_UNCHANGING_P (regno_reg_rtx[i]);
      }

      /* Save the stack slot for later.   */
      reg_equiv_memory_loc[i] = x;
    }
}

/* Mark the slots in regs_ever_live for the hard regs
   used by pseudo-reg number REGNO.  */

void
mark_home_live (regno)
     int regno;
{
  register int i, lim;
  i = reg_renumber[regno];
  if (i < 0)
    return;
  lim = i + HARD_REGNO_NREGS (i, PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (regno));
  while (i < lim)
    regs_ever_live[i++] = 1;
}

/* Mark the registers used in SCRATCH as being live.  */

static void
mark_scratch_live (scratch)
     rtx scratch;
{
  register int i;
  int regno = REGNO (scratch);
  int lim = regno + HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, GET_MODE (scratch));

  for (i = regno; i < lim; i++)
    regs_ever_live[i] = 1;
}

/* This function handles the tracking of elimination offsets around branches.

   X is a piece of RTL being scanned.

   INSN is the insn that it came from, if any.

   INITIAL_P is non-zero if we are to set the offset to be the initial
   offset and zero if we are setting the offset of the label to be the
   current offset.  */

static void
set_label_offsets (x, insn, initial_p)
     rtx x;
     rtx insn;
     int initial_p;
{
  enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
  rtx tem;
  int i;
  struct elim_table *p;

  switch (code)
    {
    case LABEL_REF:
      if (LABEL_REF_NONLOCAL_P (x))
      return;

      x = XEXP (x, 0);

      /* ... fall through ...  */

    case CODE_LABEL:
      /* If we know nothing about this label, set the desired offsets.  Note
       that this sets the offset at a label to be the offset before a label
       if we don't know anything about the label.  This is not correct for
       the label after a BARRIER, but is the best guess we can make.  If
       we guessed wrong, we will suppress an elimination that might have
       been possible had we been able to guess correctly.  */

      if (! offsets_known_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x)])
      {
        for (i = 0; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; i++)
          offsets_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x)][i]
            = (initial_p ? reg_eliminate[i].initial_offset
             : reg_eliminate[i].offset);
        offsets_known_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x)] = 1;
      }

      /* Otherwise, if this is the definition of a label and it is
       preceded by a BARRIER, set our offsets to the known offset of
       that label.  */

      else if (x == insn
             && (tem = prev_nonnote_insn (insn)) != 0
             && GET_CODE (tem) == BARRIER)
      {
        num_not_at_initial_offset = 0;
        for (i = 0; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; i++)
          {
            reg_eliminate[i].offset = reg_eliminate[i].previous_offset
            = offsets_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x)][i];
            if (reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate
              && (reg_eliminate[i].offset
                  != reg_eliminate[i].initial_offset))
            num_not_at_initial_offset++;
          }
      }

      else
      /* If neither of the above cases is true, compare each offset
         with those previously recorded and suppress any eliminations
         where the offsets disagree.  */

      for (i = 0; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; i++)
        if (offsets_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x)][i]
            != (initial_p ? reg_eliminate[i].initial_offset
              : reg_eliminate[i].offset))
          reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate = 0;

      return;

    case JUMP_INSN:
      set_label_offsets (PATTERN (insn), insn, initial_p);

      /* ... fall through ...  */

    case INSN:
    case CALL_INSN:
      /* Any labels mentioned in REG_LABEL notes can be branched to indirectly
       and hence must have all eliminations at their initial offsets.  */
      for (tem = REG_NOTES (x); tem; tem = XEXP (tem, 1))
      if (REG_NOTE_KIND (tem) == REG_LABEL)
        set_label_offsets (XEXP (tem, 0), insn, 1);
      return;

    case ADDR_VEC:
    case ADDR_DIFF_VEC:
      /* Each of the labels in the address vector must be at their initial
       offsets.  We want the first field for ADDR_VEC and the second
       field for ADDR_DIFF_VEC.  */

      for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (x, code == ADDR_DIFF_VEC); i++)
      set_label_offsets (XVECEXP (x, code == ADDR_DIFF_VEC, i),
                     insn, initial_p);
      return;

    case SET:
      /* We only care about setting PC.  If the source is not RETURN,
       IF_THEN_ELSE, or a label, disable any eliminations not at
       their initial offsets.  Similarly if any arm of the IF_THEN_ELSE
       isn't one of those possibilities.  For branches to a label,
       call ourselves recursively.

       Note that this can disable elimination unnecessarily when we have
       a non-local goto since it will look like a non-constant jump to
       someplace in the current function.  This isn't a significant
       problem since such jumps will normally be when all elimination
       pairs are back to their initial offsets.  */

      if (SET_DEST (x) != pc_rtx)
      return;

      switch (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)))
      {
      case PC:
      case RETURN:
        return;

      case LABEL_REF:
        set_label_offsets (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0), insn, initial_p);
        return;

      case IF_THEN_ELSE:
        tem = XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 1);
        if (GET_CODE (tem) == LABEL_REF)
          set_label_offsets (XEXP (tem, 0), insn, initial_p);
        else if (GET_CODE (tem) != PC && GET_CODE (tem) != RETURN)
          break;

        tem = XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 2);
        if (GET_CODE (tem) == LABEL_REF)
          set_label_offsets (XEXP (tem, 0), insn, initial_p);
        else if (GET_CODE (tem) != PC && GET_CODE (tem) != RETURN)
          break;
        return;

      default:
        break;
      }

      /* If we reach here, all eliminations must be at their initial
       offset because we are doing a jump to a variable address.  */
      for (p = reg_eliminate; p < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; p++)
      if (p->offset != p->initial_offset)
        p->can_eliminate = 0;
      break;
      
    default:
      break;
    }
}

/* Used for communication between the next two function to properly share
   the vector for an ASM_OPERANDS.  */

static struct rtvec_def *old_asm_operands_vec, *new_asm_operands_vec;

/* Scan X and replace any eliminable registers (such as fp) with a
   replacement (such as sp), plus an offset.

   MEM_MODE is the mode of an enclosing MEM.  We need this to know how
   much to adjust a register for, e.g., PRE_DEC.  Also, if we are inside a
   MEM, we are allowed to replace a sum of a register and the constant zero
   with the register, which we cannot do outside a MEM.  In addition, we need
   to record the fact that a register is referenced outside a MEM.

   If INSN is an insn, it is the insn containing X.  If we replace a REG
   in a SET_DEST with an equivalent MEM and INSN is non-zero, write a
   CLOBBER of the pseudo after INSN so find_equiv_regs will know that
   the REG is being modified.

   Alternatively, INSN may be a note (an EXPR_LIST or INSN_LIST).
   That's used when we eliminate in expressions stored in notes.
   This means, do not set ref_outside_mem even if the reference
   is outside of MEMs.

   If we see a modification to a register we know about, take the
   appropriate action (see case SET, below).

   REG_EQUIV_MEM and REG_EQUIV_ADDRESS contain address that have had
   replacements done assuming all offsets are at their initial values.  If
   they are not, or if REG_EQUIV_ADDRESS is nonzero for a pseudo we
   encounter, return the actual location so that find_reloads will do
   the proper thing.  */

rtx
eliminate_regs (x, mem_mode, insn)
     rtx x;
     enum machine_mode mem_mode;
     rtx insn;
{
  enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
  struct elim_table *ep;
  int regno;
  rtx new;
  int i, j;
  char *fmt;
  int copied = 0;

  switch (code)
    {
    case CONST_INT:
    case CONST_DOUBLE:
    case CONST:
    case SYMBOL_REF:
    case CODE_LABEL:
    case PC:
    case CC0:
    case ASM_INPUT:
    case ADDR_VEC:
    case ADDR_DIFF_VEC:
    case RETURN:
      return x;

    case ADDRESSOF:
      /* This is only for the benefit of the debugging backends, which call
       eliminate_regs on DECL_RTL; any ADDRESSOFs in the actual insns are
       removed after CSE.  */
      new = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 0), 0, insn);
      if (GET_CODE (new) == MEM)
      return XEXP (new, 0);
      return x;

    case REG:
      regno = REGNO (x);

      /* First handle the case where we encounter a bare register that
       is eliminable.  Replace it with a PLUS.  */
      if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
      {
        for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
             ep++)
          if (ep->from_rtx == x && ep->can_eliminate)
            {
            if (! mem_mode
                /* Refs inside notes don't count for this purpose.  */
                && ! (insn != 0 && (GET_CODE (insn) == EXPR_LIST
                              || GET_CODE (insn) == INSN_LIST)))
              ep->ref_outside_mem = 1;
            return plus_constant (ep->to_rtx, ep->previous_offset);
            }

      }
      else if (reg_equiv_memory_loc && reg_equiv_memory_loc[regno]
             && (reg_equiv_address[regno] || num_not_at_initial_offset))
      {
        /* In this case, find_reloads would attempt to either use an
           incorrect address (if something is not at its initial offset)
           or substitute an replaced address into an insn (which loses
           if the offset is changed by some later action).  So we simply
           return the replaced stack slot (assuming it is changed by
           elimination) and ignore the fact that this is actually a
           reference to the pseudo.  Ensure we make a copy of the
           address in case it is shared.  */
        new = eliminate_regs (reg_equiv_memory_loc[regno], mem_mode, insn);
        if (new != reg_equiv_memory_loc[regno])
          {
            if (insn != 0 && GET_CODE (insn) != EXPR_LIST
              && GET_CODE (insn) != INSN_LIST)
            REG_NOTES (emit_insn_before (gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, x), insn))
              = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_EQUAL, new, NULL_RTX);
            return copy_rtx (new);
          }
      }
      return x;

    case PLUS:
      /* If this is the sum of an eliminable register and a constant, rework
       the sum.   */
      if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG
        && REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
        && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (x, 1)))
      {
        for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
             ep++)
          if (ep->from_rtx == XEXP (x, 0) && ep->can_eliminate)
            {
            if (! mem_mode
                /* Refs inside notes don't count for this purpose.  */
                && ! (insn != 0 && (GET_CODE (insn) == EXPR_LIST
                              || GET_CODE (insn) == INSN_LIST)))
              ep->ref_outside_mem = 1;

            /* The only time we want to replace a PLUS with a REG (this
               occurs when the constant operand of the PLUS is the negative
               of the offset) is when we are inside a MEM.  We won't want
               to do so at other times because that would change the
               structure of the insn in a way that reload can't handle.
               We special-case the commonest situation in
               eliminate_regs_in_insn, so just replace a PLUS with a
               PLUS here, unless inside a MEM.  */
            if (mem_mode != 0 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
                && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) == - ep->previous_offset)
              return ep->to_rtx;
            else
              return gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, ep->to_rtx,
                               plus_constant (XEXP (x, 1),
                                          ep->previous_offset));
            }

        /* If the register is not eliminable, we are done since the other
           operand is a constant.  */
        return x;
      }

      /* If this is part of an address, we want to bring any constant to the
       outermost PLUS.  We will do this by doing register replacement in
       our operands and seeing if a constant shows up in one of them.

       We assume here this is part of an address (or a "load address" insn)
       since an eliminable register is not likely to appear in any other
       context.

       If we have (plus (eliminable) (reg)), we want to produce
       (plus (plus (replacement) (reg) (const))).  If this was part of a
       normal add insn, (plus (replacement) (reg)) will be pushed as a
       reload.  This is the desired action.  */

      {
      rtx new0 = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn);
      rtx new1 = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 1), mem_mode, insn);

      if (new0 != XEXP (x, 0) || new1 != XEXP (x, 1))
        {
          /* If one side is a PLUS and the other side is a pseudo that
             didn't get a hard register but has a reg_equiv_constant,
             we must replace the constant here since it may no longer
             be in the position of any operand.  */
          if (GET_CODE (new0) == PLUS && GET_CODE (new1) == REG
            && REGNO (new1) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
            && reg_renumber[REGNO (new1)] < 0
            && reg_equiv_constant != 0
            && reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (new1)] != 0)
            new1 = reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (new1)];
          else if (GET_CODE (new1) == PLUS && GET_CODE (new0) == REG
                 && REGNO (new0) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
                 && reg_renumber[REGNO (new0)] < 0
                 && reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (new0)] != 0)
            new0 = reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (new0)];

          new = form_sum (new0, new1);

          /* As above, if we are not inside a MEM we do not want to
             turn a PLUS into something else.  We might try to do so here
             for an addition of 0 if we aren't optimizing.  */
          if (! mem_mode && GET_CODE (new) != PLUS)
            return gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (x), new, const0_rtx);
          else
            return new;
        }
      }
      return x;

    case MULT:
      /* If this is the product of an eliminable register and a 
       constant, apply the distribute law and move the constant out
       so that we have (plus (mult ..) ..).  This is needed in order
       to keep load-address insns valid.   This case is pathological.
       We ignore the possibility of overflow here.  */
      if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG
        && REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
        && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT)
      for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
           ep++)
        if (ep->from_rtx == XEXP (x, 0) && ep->can_eliminate)
          {
            if (! mem_mode
              /* Refs inside notes don't count for this purpose.  */
              && ! (insn != 0 && (GET_CODE (insn) == EXPR_LIST
                              || GET_CODE (insn) == INSN_LIST)))
            ep->ref_outside_mem = 1;

            return
            plus_constant (gen_rtx_MULT (Pmode, ep->to_rtx, XEXP (x, 1)),
                         ep->previous_offset * INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)));
          }

      /* ... fall through ...  */

    case CALL:
    case COMPARE:
    case MINUS:
    case DIV:      case UDIV:
    case MOD:      case UMOD:
    case AND:      case IOR:      case XOR:
    case ROTATERT: case ROTATE:
    case ASHIFTRT: case LSHIFTRT: case ASHIFT:
    case NE:       case EQ:
    case GE:       case GT:       case GEU:    case GTU:
    case LE:       case LT:       case LEU:    case LTU:
      {
      rtx new0 = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn);
      rtx new1
        = XEXP (x, 1) ? eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 1), mem_mode, insn) : 0;

      if (new0 != XEXP (x, 0) || new1 != XEXP (x, 1))
        return gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, GET_MODE (x), new0, new1);
      }
      return x;

    case EXPR_LIST:
      /* If we have something in XEXP (x, 0), the usual case, eliminate it.  */
      if (XEXP (x, 0))
      {
        new = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn);
        if (new != XEXP (x, 0))
          x = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_NOTE_KIND (x), new, XEXP (x, 1));
      }

      /* ... fall through ...  */

    case INSN_LIST:
      /* Now do eliminations in the rest of the chain.  If this was
       an EXPR_LIST, this might result in allocating more memory than is
       strictly needed, but it simplifies the code.  */
      if (XEXP (x, 1))
      {
        new = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 1), mem_mode, insn);
        if (new != XEXP (x, 1))
          return gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (x), GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0), new);
      }
      return x;

    case PRE_INC:
    case POST_INC:
    case PRE_DEC:
    case POST_DEC:
      for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
      if (ep->to_rtx == XEXP (x, 0))
        {
          int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mem_mode);

          /* If more bytes than MEM_MODE are pushed, account for them.  */
#ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
          if (ep->to_rtx == stack_pointer_rtx)
            size = PUSH_ROUNDING (size);
#endif
          if (code == PRE_DEC || code == POST_DEC)
            ep->offset += size;
          else
            ep->offset -= size;
        }

      /* Fall through to generic unary operation case.  */
    case STRICT_LOW_PART:
    case NEG:          case NOT:
    case SIGN_EXTEND:  case ZERO_EXTEND:
    case TRUNCATE:     case FLOAT_EXTEND: case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
    case FLOAT:        case FIX:
    case UNSIGNED_FIX: case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
    case ABS:
    case SQRT:
    case FFS:
      new = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn);
      if (new != XEXP (x, 0))
      return gen_rtx_fmt_e (code, GET_MODE (x), new);
      return x;

    case SUBREG:
      /* Similar to above processing, but preserve SUBREG_WORD.
       Convert (subreg (mem)) to (mem) if not paradoxical.
       Also, if we have a non-paradoxical (subreg (pseudo)) and the
       pseudo didn't get a hard reg, we must replace this with the
       eliminated version of the memory location because push_reloads
       may do the replacement in certain circumstances.  */
      if (GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (x)) == REG
        && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))
            <= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))))
        && reg_equiv_memory_loc != 0
        && reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x))] != 0)
      {
        new = eliminate_regs (reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x))],
                        mem_mode, insn);

        /* If we didn't change anything, we must retain the pseudo.  */
        if (new == reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x))])
          new = SUBREG_REG (x);
        else
          {
            /* In this case, we must show that the pseudo is used in this
             insn so that delete_output_reload will do the right thing.  */
            if (insn != 0 && GET_CODE (insn) != EXPR_LIST
              && GET_CODE (insn) != INSN_LIST)
            REG_NOTES (emit_insn_before (gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode,
                                            SUBREG_REG (x)),
                                            insn))
              = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_EQUAL, new, NULL_RTX);

            /* Ensure NEW isn't shared in case we have to reload it.  */
            new = copy_rtx (new);
          }
      }
      else
      new = eliminate_regs (SUBREG_REG (x), mem_mode, insn);

      if (new != XEXP (x, 0))
      {
        int x_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x));
        int new_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (new));

        if (GET_CODE (new) == MEM
            && ((x_size < new_size
#ifdef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
               /* On these machines, combine can create rtl of the form
                  (set (subreg:m1 (reg:m2 R) 0) ...)
                  where m1 < m2, and expects something interesting to 
                  happen to the entire word.  Moreover, it will use the
                  (reg:m2 R) later, expecting all bits to be preserved.
                  So if the number of words is the same, preserve the 
                  subreg so that push_reloads can see it.  */
               && ! ((x_size-1)/UNITS_PER_WORD == (new_size-1)/UNITS_PER_WORD)
#endif
               )
              || (x_size == new_size))
            )
          {
            int offset = SUBREG_WORD (x) * UNITS_PER_WORD;
            enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);

            if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
            offset += (MIN (UNITS_PER_WORD,
                        GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (new)))
                     - MIN (UNITS_PER_WORD, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)));

            PUT_MODE (new, mode);
            XEXP (new, 0) = plus_constant (XEXP (new, 0), offset);
            return new;
          }
        else
          return gen_rtx_SUBREG (GET_MODE (x), new, SUBREG_WORD (x));
      }

      return x;

    case USE:
      /* If using a register that is the source of an eliminate we still
       think can be performed, note it cannot be performed since we don't
       know how this register is used.  */
      for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
      if (ep->from_rtx == XEXP (x, 0))
        ep->can_eliminate = 0;

      new = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn);
      if (new != XEXP (x, 0))
      return gen_rtx_fmt_e (code, GET_MODE (x), new);
      return x;

    case CLOBBER:
      /* If clobbering a register that is the replacement register for an
       elimination we still think can be performed, note that it cannot
       be performed.  Otherwise, we need not be concerned about it.  */
      for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
      if (ep->to_rtx == XEXP (x, 0))
        ep->can_eliminate = 0;

      new = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn);
      if (new != XEXP (x, 0))
      return gen_rtx_fmt_e (code, GET_MODE (x), new);
      return x;

    case ASM_OPERANDS:
      {
      rtx *temp_vec;
      /* Properly handle sharing input and constraint vectors.  */
      if (ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_VEC (x) != old_asm_operands_vec)
        {
          /* When we come to a new vector not seen before,
             scan all its elements; keep the old vector if none
             of them changes; otherwise, make a copy.  */
          old_asm_operands_vec = ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_VEC (x);
          temp_vec = (rtx *) alloca (XVECLEN (x, 3) * sizeof (rtx));
          for (i = 0; i < ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_LENGTH (x); i++)
            temp_vec[i] = eliminate_regs (ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT (x, i),
                                  mem_mode, insn);

          for (i = 0; i < ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_LENGTH (x); i++)
            if (temp_vec[i] != ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT (x, i))
            break;

          if (i == ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_LENGTH (x))
            new_asm_operands_vec = old_asm_operands_vec;
          else
            new_asm_operands_vec
            = gen_rtvec_v (ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_LENGTH (x), temp_vec);
        }

      /* If we had to copy the vector, copy the entire ASM_OPERANDS.  */
      if (new_asm_operands_vec == old_asm_operands_vec)
        return x;

      new = gen_rtx_ASM_OPERANDS (VOIDmode, ASM_OPERANDS_TEMPLATE (x),
                            ASM_OPERANDS_OUTPUT_CONSTRAINT (x),
                            ASM_OPERANDS_OUTPUT_IDX (x),
                            new_asm_operands_vec,
                            ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_CONSTRAINT_VEC (x),
                            ASM_OPERANDS_SOURCE_FILE (x),
                            ASM_OPERANDS_SOURCE_LINE (x));
      new->volatil = x->volatil;
      return new;
      }

    case SET:
      /* Check for setting a register that we know about.  */
      if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == REG)
      {
        /* See if this is setting the replacement register for an
           elimination.

           If DEST is the hard frame pointer, we do nothing because we
           assume that all assignments to the frame pointer are for
           non-local gotos and are being done at a time when they are valid
           and do not disturb anything else.  Some machines want to
           eliminate a fake argument pointer (or even a fake frame pointer)
           with either the real frame or the stack pointer.  Assignments to
           the hard frame pointer must not prevent this elimination.  */

        for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
             ep++)
          if (ep->to_rtx == SET_DEST (x)
            && SET_DEST (x) != hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
            {
            /* If it is being incremented, adjust the offset.  Otherwise,
               this elimination can't be done.  */
            rtx src = SET_SRC (x);

            if (GET_CODE (src) == PLUS
                && XEXP (src, 0) == SET_DEST (x)
                && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
              ep->offset -= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
            else
              ep->can_eliminate = 0;
            }

        /* Now check to see we are assigning to a register that can be
           eliminated.  If so, it must be as part of a PARALLEL, since we
           will not have been called if this is a single SET.  So indicate
           that we can no longer eliminate this reg.  */
        for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
             ep++)
          if (ep->from_rtx == SET_DEST (x) && ep->can_eliminate)
            ep->can_eliminate = 0;
      }

      /* Now avoid the loop below in this common case.  */
      {
      rtx new0 = eliminate_regs (SET_DEST (x), 0, insn);
      rtx new1 = eliminate_regs (SET_SRC (x), 0, insn);

      /* If SET_DEST changed from a REG to a MEM and INSN is an insn,
         write a CLOBBER insn.  */
      if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == REG && GET_CODE (new0) == MEM
          && insn != 0 && GET_CODE (insn) != EXPR_LIST
          && GET_CODE (insn) != INSN_LIST)
        emit_insn_after (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, SET_DEST (x)), insn);

      if (new0 != SET_DEST (x) || new1 != SET_SRC (x))
        return gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, new0, new1);
      }

      return x;

    case MEM:
      /* This is only for the benefit of the debugging backends, which call
       eliminate_regs on DECL_RTL; any ADDRESSOFs in the actual insns are
       removed after CSE.  */
      if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == ADDRESSOF)
      return eliminate_regs (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), 0, insn);

      /* Our only special processing is to pass the mode of the MEM to our
       recursive call and copy the flags.  While we are here, handle this
       case more efficiently.  */
      new = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, 0), GET_MODE (x), insn);
      if (new != XEXP (x, 0))
      {
        new = gen_rtx_MEM (GET_MODE (x), new);
        new->volatil = x->volatil;
        new->unchanging = x->unchanging;
        new->in_struct = x->in_struct;
        return new;
      }
      else
      return x;
      
    default:
      break;
    }

  /* Process each of our operands recursively.  If any have changed, make a
     copy of the rtx.  */
  fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
  for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++, fmt++)
    {
      if (*fmt == 'e')
      {
        new = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x, i), mem_mode, insn);
        if (new != XEXP (x, i) && ! copied)
          {
            rtx new_x = rtx_alloc (code);
            bcopy ((char *) x, (char *) new_x,
                 (sizeof (*new_x) - sizeof (new_x->fld)
                  + sizeof (new_x->fld[0]) * GET_RTX_LENGTH (code)));
            x = new_x;
            copied = 1;
          }
        XEXP (x, i) = new;
      }
      else if (*fmt == 'E')
      {
        int copied_vec = 0;
        for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
          {
            new = eliminate_regs (XVECEXP (x, i, j), mem_mode, insn);
            if (new != XVECEXP (x, i, j) && ! copied_vec)
            {
              rtvec new_v = gen_rtvec_vv (XVECLEN (x, i),
                                    XVEC (x, i)->elem);
              if (! copied)
                {
                  rtx new_x = rtx_alloc (code);
                  bcopy ((char *) x, (char *) new_x,
                       (sizeof (*new_x) - sizeof (new_x->fld)
                        + (sizeof (new_x->fld[0])
                         * GET_RTX_LENGTH (code))));
                  x = new_x;
                  copied = 1;
                }
              XVEC (x, i) = new_v;
              copied_vec = 1;
            }
            XVECEXP (x, i, j) = new;
          }
      }
    }

  return x;
}

/* Scan INSN and eliminate all eliminable registers in it.

   If REPLACE is nonzero, do the replacement destructively.  Also
   delete the insn as dead it if it is setting an eliminable register.

   If REPLACE is zero, do all our allocations in reload_obstack.

   If no eliminations were done and this insn doesn't require any elimination
   processing (these are not identical conditions: it might be updating sp,
   but not referencing fp; this needs to be seen during reload_as_needed so
   that the offset between fp and sp can be taken into consideration), zero
   is returned.  Otherwise, 1 is returned.  */

static int
eliminate_regs_in_insn (insn, replace)
     rtx insn;
     int replace;
{
  rtx old_body = PATTERN (insn);
  rtx old_set = single_set (insn);
  rtx new_body;
  int val = 0;
  struct elim_table *ep;

  if (! replace)
    push_obstacks (&reload_obstack, &reload_obstack);

  if (old_set != 0 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (old_set)) == REG
      && REGNO (SET_DEST (old_set)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
    {
      /* Check for setting an eliminable register.  */
      for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
      if (ep->from_rtx == SET_DEST (old_set) && ep->can_eliminate)
        {
#if HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
          /* If this is setting the frame pointer register to the
             hardware frame pointer register and this is an elimination
             that will be done (tested above), this insn is really
             adjusting the frame pointer downward to compensate for
             the adjustment done before a nonlocal goto.  */
          if (ep->from == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
            && ep->to == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
            {
            rtx src = SET_SRC (old_set);
            int offset, ok = 0;
            rtx prev_insn, prev_set;

            if (src == ep->to_rtx)
              offset = 0, ok = 1;
            else if (GET_CODE (src) == PLUS
                   && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) == CONST_INT
                   && XEXP (src, 1) == ep->to_rtx)
              offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 0)), ok = 1;
            else if (GET_CODE (src) == PLUS
                   && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT
                   && XEXP (src, 0) == ep->to_rtx)
              offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1)), ok = 1;
            else if ((prev_insn = prev_nonnote_insn (insn)) != 0
                   && (prev_set = single_set (prev_insn)) != 0
                   && rtx_equal_p (SET_DEST (prev_set), src))
              {
                src = SET_SRC (prev_set);
                if (src == ep->to_rtx)
                  offset = 0, ok = 1;
                else if (GET_CODE (src) == PLUS
                       && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) == CONST_INT
                       && XEXP (src, 1) == ep->to_rtx)
                  offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 0)), ok = 1;
                else if (GET_CODE (src) == PLUS
                       && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT
                       && XEXP (src, 0) == ep->to_rtx)
                  offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1)), ok = 1;
              }

            if (ok)
              {
                if (replace)
                  {
                  rtx src
                    = plus_constant (ep->to_rtx, offset - ep->offset);

                  /* First see if this insn remains valid when we
                     make the change.  If not, keep the INSN_CODE
                     the same and let reload fit it up.  */
                  validate_change (insn, &SET_SRC (old_set), src, 1);
                  validate_change (insn, &SET_DEST (old_set),
                               ep->to_rtx, 1);
                  if (! apply_change_group ())
                    {
                      SET_SRC (old_set) = src;
                      SET_DEST (old_set) = ep->to_rtx;
                    }
                  }

                val = 1;
                goto done;
              }
            }
#endif

          /* In this case this insn isn't serving a useful purpose.  We
             will delete it in reload_as_needed once we know that this
             elimination is, in fact, being done.

             If REPLACE isn't set, we can't delete this insn, but needn't
             process it since it won't be used unless something changes.  */
          if (replace)
            delete_dead_insn (insn);
          val = 1;
          goto done;
        }

      /* Check for (set (reg) (plus (reg from) (offset))) where the offset
       in the insn is the negative of the offset in FROM.  Substitute
       (set (reg) (reg to)) for the insn and change its code.

       We have to do this here, rather than in eliminate_regs, do that we can
       change the insn code.  */

      if (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (old_set)) == PLUS
        && GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (old_set), 0)) == REG
        && GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (old_set), 1)) == CONST_INT)
      for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
           ep++)
        if (ep->from_rtx == XEXP (SET_SRC (old_set), 0)
            && ep->can_eliminate)
          {
            /* We must stop at the first elimination that will be used.
             If this one would replace the PLUS with a REG, do it
             now.  Otherwise, quit the loop and let eliminate_regs
             do its normal replacement.  */
            if (ep->offset == - INTVAL (XEXP (SET_SRC (old_set), 1)))
            {
              /* We assume here that we don't need a PARALLEL of
                 any CLOBBERs for this assignment.  There's not
                 much we can do if we do need it.  */
              PATTERN (insn) = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
                                    SET_DEST (old_set),
                                    ep->to_rtx);
              INSN_CODE (insn) = -1;
              val = 1;
              goto done;
            }

            break;
          }
    }

  old_asm_operands_vec = 0;

  /* Replace the body of this insn with a substituted form.  If we changed
     something, return non-zero.  

     If we are replacing a body that was a (set X (plus Y Z)), try to
     re-recognize the insn.  We do this in case we had a simple addition
     but now can do this as a load-address.  This saves an insn in this
     common case.  */

  new_body = eliminate_regs (old_body, 0, replace ? insn : NULL_RTX);
  if (new_body != old_body)
    {
      /* If we aren't replacing things permanently and we changed something,
       make another copy to ensure that all the RTL is new.  Otherwise
       things can go wrong if find_reload swaps commutative operands
       and one is inside RTL that has been copied while the other is not.  */

      /* Don't copy an asm_operands because (1) there's no need and (2)
       copy_rtx can't do it properly when there are multiple outputs.  */
      if (! replace && asm_noperands (old_body) < 0)
      new_body = copy_rtx (new_body);

      /* If we had a move insn but now we don't, rerecognize it.  This will
       cause spurious re-recognition if the old move had a PARALLEL since
       the new one still will, but we can't call single_set without
       having put NEW_BODY into the insn and the re-recognition won't
       hurt in this rare case.  */
      if (old_set != 0
        && ((GET_CODE (SET_SRC (old_set)) == REG
             && (GET_CODE (new_body) != SET
               || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (new_body)) != REG))
            /* If this was a load from or store to memory, compare
             the MEM in recog_operand to the one in the insn.  If they
             are not equal, then rerecognize the insn.  */
            || (old_set != 0
              && ((GET_CODE (SET_SRC (old_set)) == MEM
                   && SET_SRC (old_set) != recog_operand[1])
                  || (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (old_set)) == MEM
                    && SET_DEST (old_set) != recog_operand[0])))
            /* If this was an add insn before, rerecognize.  */
            || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (old_set)) == PLUS))
      {
        if (! validate_change (insn, &PATTERN (insn), new_body, 0))
          /* If recognition fails, store the new body anyway.
             It's normal to have recognition failures here
             due to bizarre memory addresses; reloading will fix them.  */
          PATTERN (insn) = new_body;
      }
      else
      PATTERN (insn) = new_body;

      val = 1;
    }

  /* Loop through all elimination pairs.  See if any have changed and
     recalculate the number not at initial offset.

     Compute the maximum offset (minimum offset if the stack does not
     grow downward) for each elimination pair.

     We also detect a cases where register elimination cannot be done,
     namely, if a register would be both changed and referenced outside a MEM
     in the resulting insn since such an insn is often undefined and, even if
     not, we cannot know what meaning will be given to it.  Note that it is
     valid to have a register used in an address in an insn that changes it
     (presumably with a pre- or post-increment or decrement).

     If anything changes, return nonzero.  */

  num_not_at_initial_offset = 0;
  for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
    {
      if (ep->previous_offset != ep->offset && ep->ref_outside_mem)
      ep->can_eliminate = 0;

      ep->ref_outside_mem = 0;

      if (ep->previous_offset != ep->offset)
      val = 1;

      ep->previous_offset = ep->offset;
      if (ep->can_eliminate && ep->offset != ep->initial_offset)
      num_not_at_initial_offset++;

#ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
      ep->max_offset = MAX (ep->max_offset, ep->offset);
#else
      ep->max_offset = MIN (ep->max_offset, ep->offset);
#endif
    }

 done:
  /* If we changed something, perform elimination in REG_NOTES.  This is
     needed even when REPLACE is zero because a REG_DEAD note might refer
     to a register that we eliminate and could cause a different number
     of spill registers to be needed in the final reload pass than in
     the pre-passes.  */
  if (val && REG_NOTES (insn) != 0)
    REG_NOTES (insn) = eliminate_regs (REG_NOTES (insn), 0, REG_NOTES (insn));

  if (! replace)
    pop_obstacks ();

  return val;
}

/* Given X, a SET or CLOBBER of DEST, if DEST is the target of a register
   replacement we currently believe is valid, mark it as not eliminable if X
   modifies DEST in any way other than by adding a constant integer to it.

   If DEST is the frame pointer, we do nothing because we assume that
   all assignments to the hard frame pointer are nonlocal gotos and are being
   done at a time when they are valid and do not disturb anything else.
   Some machines want to eliminate a fake argument pointer with either the
   frame or stack pointer.  Assignments to the hard frame pointer must not
   prevent this elimination.

   Called via note_stores from reload before starting its passes to scan
   the insns of the function.  */

static void
mark_not_eliminable (dest, x)
     rtx dest;
     rtx x;
{
  register int i;

  /* A SUBREG of a hard register here is just changing its mode.  We should
     not see a SUBREG of an eliminable hard register, but check just in
     case.  */
  if (GET_CODE (dest) == SUBREG)
    dest = SUBREG_REG (dest);

  if (dest == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
    return;

  for (i = 0; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; i++)
    if (reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate && dest == reg_eliminate[i].to_rtx
      && (GET_CODE (x) != SET
          || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)) != PLUS
          || XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0) != dest
          || GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 1)) != CONST_INT))
      {
      reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate_previous
        = reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate = 0;
      num_eliminable--;
      }
}

/* Kick all pseudos out of hard register REGNO.
   If GLOBAL is nonzero, try to find someplace else to put them.
   If DUMPFILE is nonzero, log actions taken on that file.

   If CANT_ELIMINATE is nonzero, it means that we are doing this spill
   because we found we can't eliminate some register.  In the case, no pseudos
   are allowed to be in the register, even if they are only in a block that
   doesn't require spill registers, unlike the case when we are spilling this
   hard reg to produce another spill register.

   Return nonzero if any pseudos needed to be kicked out.  */

static int
spill_hard_reg (regno, global, dumpfile, cant_eliminate)
     register int regno;
     int global;
     FILE *dumpfile;
     int cant_eliminate;
{
  enum reg_class class = REGNO_REG_CLASS (regno);
  int something_changed = 0;
  register int i;

  SET_HARD_REG_BIT (forbidden_regs, regno);

  if (cant_eliminate)
    regs_ever_live[regno] = 1;

  /* Spill every pseudo reg that was allocated to this reg
     or to something that overlaps this reg.  */

  for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
    if (reg_renumber[i] >= 0
      && reg_renumber[i] <= regno
      && (reg_renumber[i]
          + HARD_REGNO_NREGS (reg_renumber[i],
                        PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (i))
          > regno))
      {
      /* If this register belongs solely to a basic block which needed no
         spilling of any class that this register is contained in,
         leave it be, unless we are spilling this register because
         it was a hard register that can't be eliminated.   */

      if (! cant_eliminate
          && basic_block_needs[0]
          && REG_BASIC_BLOCK (i) >= 0
          && basic_block_needs[(int) class][REG_BASIC_BLOCK (i)] == 0)
        {
          enum reg_class *p;

          for (p = reg_class_superclasses[(int) class];
             *p != LIM_REG_CLASSES; p++)
            if (basic_block_needs[(int) *p][REG_BASIC_BLOCK (i)] > 0)
            break;

          if (*p == LIM_REG_CLASSES)
            continue;
        }

      /* Mark it as no longer having a hard register home.  */
      reg_renumber[i] = -1;
      /* We will need to scan everything again.  */
      something_changed = 1;
      if (global)
        retry_global_alloc (i, forbidden_regs);

      alter_reg (i, regno);
      if (dumpfile)
        {
          if (reg_renumber[i] == -1)
            fprintf (dumpfile, " Register %d now on stack.\n\n", i);
          else
            fprintf (dumpfile, " Register %d now in %d.\n\n",
                   i, reg_renumber[i]);
        }
      }
  for (i = 0; i < scratch_list_length; i++)
    {
     if (scratch_list[i] 
          && regno >= REGNO (scratch_list[i]) 
          && regno <  REGNO (scratch_list[i]) 
                      + HARD_REGNO_NREGS (REGNO (scratch_list[i]),
                                          GET_MODE (scratch_list[i])))
      {
        if (! cant_eliminate && basic_block_needs[0]
            && ! basic_block_needs[(int) class][scratch_block[i]])
          {
            enum reg_class *p;

            for (p = reg_class_superclasses[(int) class];
               *p != LIM_REG_CLASSES; p++)
            if (basic_block_needs[(int) *p][scratch_block[i]] > 0)
              break;

            if (*p == LIM_REG_CLASSES)
            continue;
          }
        PUT_CODE (scratch_list[i], SCRATCH);
        scratch_list[i] = 0;
        something_changed = 1;
        continue;
      }
    }

  return something_changed;
}

/* Find all paradoxical subregs within X and update reg_max_ref_width. 
   Also mark any hard registers used to store user variables as
   forbidden from being used for spill registers.  */

static void
scan_paradoxical_subregs (x)
     register rtx x;
{
  register int i;
  register char *fmt;
  register enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);

  switch (code)
    {
    case REG:
      if (SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
        && REG_USERVAR_P (x))
      SET_HARD_REG_BIT (forbidden_regs, REGNO (x));
      return;

    case CONST_INT:
    case CONST:
    case SYMBOL_REF:
    case LABEL_REF:
    case CONST_DOUBLE:
    case CC0:
    case PC:
    case USE:
    case CLOBBER:
      return;

    case SUBREG:
      if (GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (x)) == REG
        && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)) > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))))
      reg_max_ref_width[REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x))]
        = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x));
      return;
      
    default:
      break;
    }

  fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
  for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
    {
      if (fmt[i] == 'e')
      scan_paradoxical_subregs (XEXP (x, i));
      else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
      {
        register int j;
        for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >=0; j--)
          scan_paradoxical_subregs (XVECEXP (x, i, j));
      }
    }
}

static int
hard_reg_use_compare (p1p, p2p)
  const GENERIC_PTR p1p;
  const GENERIC_PTR p2p;
{
  struct hard_reg_n_uses *p1 = (struct hard_reg_n_uses *)p1p,
                   *p2 = (struct hard_reg_n_uses *)p2p;
  int tem = p1->uses - p2->uses;
  if (tem != 0) return tem;
  /* If regs are equally good, sort by regno,
     so that the results of qsort leave nothing to chance.  */
  return p1->regno - p2->regno;
}

/* Choose the order to consider regs for use as reload registers
   based on how much trouble would be caused by spilling one.
   Store them in order of decreasing preference in potential_reload_regs.  */

static void
order_regs_for_reload (global)
     int global;
{
  register int i;
  register int o = 0;
  int large = 0;

  struct hard_reg_n_uses hard_reg_n_uses[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];

  CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (bad_spill_regs);

  for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
    potential_reload_regs[i] = -1;

  /* Count number of uses of each hard reg by pseudo regs allocated to it
     and then order them by decreasing use.  */

  for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
    {
      hard_reg_n_uses[i].uses = 0;
      hard_reg_n_uses[i].regno = i;
    }

  for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
    {
      int regno = reg_renumber[i];
      if (regno >= 0)
      {
        int lim = regno + HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (i));
        while (regno < lim)
          {
            /* If allocated by local-alloc, show more uses since
             we're not going to be able to reallocate it, but
             we might if allocated by global alloc.  */
            if (global && reg_allocno[i] < 0)
            hard_reg_n_uses[regno].uses += (REG_N_REFS (i) + 1) / 2;

            hard_reg_n_uses[regno++].uses += REG_N_REFS (i);
          }
      }
      large += REG_N_REFS (i);
    }

  /* Now fixed registers (which cannot safely be used for reloading)
     get a very high use count so they will be considered least desirable.
     Registers used explicitly in the rtl code are almost as bad.  */

  for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
    {
      if (fixed_regs[i])
      {
        hard_reg_n_uses[i].uses += 2 * large + 2;
        SET_HARD_REG_BIT (bad_spill_regs, i);
      }
      else if (regs_explicitly_used[i])
      {
        hard_reg_n_uses[i].uses += large + 1;
        if (! SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES)
          /* ??? We are doing this here because of the potential
           that bad code may be generated if a register explicitly
           used in an insn was used as a spill register for that
           insn.  But not using these are spill registers may lose
           on some machine.  We'll have to see how this works out.  */
          SET_HARD_REG_BIT (bad_spill_regs, i);
      }
    }
  hard_reg_n_uses[HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM].uses += 2 * large + 2;
  SET_HARD_REG_BIT (bad_spill_regs, HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);

#ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
  /* If registers other than the frame pointer are eliminable, mark them as
     poor choices.  */
  for (i = 0; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; i++)
    {
      hard_reg_n_uses[reg_eliminate[i].from].uses += 2 * large + 2;
      SET_HARD_REG_BIT (bad_spill_regs, reg_eliminate[i].from);
    }
#endif

  /* Prefer registers not so far used, for use in temporary loading.
     Among them, if REG_ALLOC_ORDER is defined, use that order.
     Otherwise, prefer registers not preserved by calls.  */

#ifdef REG_ALLOC_ORDER
  for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
    {
      int regno = reg_alloc_order[i];

      if (hard_reg_n_uses[regno].uses == 0)
      potential_reload_regs[o++] = regno;
    }
#else
  for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
    {
      if (hard_reg_n_uses[i].uses == 0 && call_used_regs[i])
      potential_reload_regs[o++] = i;
    }
  for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
    {
      if (hard_reg_n_uses[i].uses == 0 && ! call_used_regs[i])
      potential_reload_regs[o++] = i;
    }
#endif

  qsort (hard_reg_n_uses, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER,
       sizeof hard_reg_n_uses[0], hard_reg_use_compare);

  /* Now add the regs that are already used,
     preferring those used less often.  The fixed and otherwise forbidden
     registers will be at the end of this list.  */

  for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
    if (hard_reg_n_uses[i].uses != 0)
      potential_reload_regs[o++] = hard_reg_n_uses[i].regno;
}

/* Used in reload_as_needed to sort the spilled regs.  */

static int
compare_spill_regs (r1p, r2p)
     const GENERIC_PTR r1p;
     const GENERIC_PTR r2p;
{
  short r1 = *(short *)r1p, r2 = *(short *)r2p;
  return r1 - r2;
}

/* Reload pseudo-registers into hard regs around each insn as needed.
   Additional register load insns are output before the insn that needs it
   and perhaps store insns after insns that modify the reloaded pseudo reg.

   reg_last_reload_reg and reg_reloaded_contents keep track of
   which registers are already available in reload registers.
   We update these for the reloads that we perform,
   as the insns are scanned.  */

static void
reload_as_needed (first, live_known)
     rtx first;
     int live_known;
{
  register rtx insn;
  register int i;
  int this_block = 0;
  rtx x;
  rtx after_call = 0;

  bzero ((char *) spill_reg_rtx, sizeof spill_reg_rtx);
  bzero ((char *) spill_reg_store, sizeof spill_reg_store);
  reg_last_reload_reg = (rtx *) alloca (max_regno * sizeof (rtx));
  bzero ((char *) reg_last_reload_reg, max_regno * sizeof (rtx));
  reg_has_output_reload = (char *) alloca (max_regno);
  CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_valid);

  /* Reset all offsets on eliminable registers to their initial values.  */
#ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
  for (i = 0; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; i++)
    {
      INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (reg_eliminate[i].from, reg_eliminate[i].to,
                          reg_eliminate[i].initial_offset);
      reg_eliminate[i].previous_offset
      = reg_eliminate[i].offset = reg_eliminate[i].initial_offset;
    }
#else
  INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (reg_eliminate[0].initial_offset);
  reg_eliminate[0].previous_offset
    = reg_eliminate[0].offset = reg_eliminate[0].initial_offset;
#endif

  num_not_at_initial_offset = 0;

  /* Order the spilled regs, so that allocate_reload_regs can guarantee to
     pack registers with group needs.  */
  if (n_spills > 1)
    {
      qsort (spill_regs, n_spills, sizeof (short), compare_spill_regs);
      for (i = 0; i < n_spills; i++)
      spill_reg_order[spill_regs[i]] = i;
    }

  for (insn = first; insn;)
    {
      register rtx next = NEXT_INSN (insn);

      /* Notice when we move to a new basic block.  */
      if (live_known && this_block + 1 < n_basic_blocks
        && insn == basic_block_head[this_block+1])
      ++this_block;

      /* If we pass a label, copy the offsets from the label information
       into the current offsets of each elimination.  */
      if (GET_CODE (insn) == CODE_LABEL)
      {
        num_not_at_initial_offset = 0;
        for (i = 0; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; i++)
          {
            reg_eliminate[i].offset = reg_eliminate[i].previous_offset
            = offsets_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn)][i];
            if (reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate
              && (reg_eliminate[i].offset
                  != reg_eliminate[i].initial_offset))
            num_not_at_initial_offset++;
          }
      }

      else if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (insn)) == 'i')
      {
        rtx avoid_return_reg = 0;
        rtx oldpat = PATTERN (insn);

        /* Set avoid_return_reg if this is an insn
           that might use the value of a function call.  */
        if (SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES && GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
          {
            if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
            after_call = SET_DEST (PATTERN (insn));
            else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
                   && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, 0)) == SET)
            after_call = SET_DEST (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, 0));
            else
            after_call = 0;
          }
        else if (SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES && after_call != 0
               && !(GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET
                  && SET_DEST (PATTERN (insn)) == stack_pointer_rtx)
               && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != USE)
          {
            if (reg_referenced_p (after_call, PATTERN (insn)))
            avoid_return_reg = after_call;
            after_call = 0;
          }

        /* If this is a USE and CLOBBER of a MEM, ensure that any
           references to eliminable registers have been removed.  */

        if ((GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE
             || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER)
            && GET_CODE (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0)) == MEM)
          XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0), 0)
            = eliminate_regs (XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0), 0),
                        GET_MODE (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0)),
                        NULL_RTX);

        /* If we need to do register elimination processing, do so.
           This might delete the insn, in which case we are done.  */
        if (num_eliminable && GET_MODE (insn) == QImode)
          {
            eliminate_regs_in_insn (insn, 1);
            if (GET_CODE (insn) == NOTE)
            {
              insn = next;
              continue;
            }
          }

        if (GET_MODE (insn) == VOIDmode)
          n_reloads = 0;
        /* First find the pseudo regs that must be reloaded for this insn.
           This info is returned in the tables reload_... (see reload.h).
           Also modify the body of INSN by substituting RELOAD
           rtx's for those pseudo regs.  */
        else
          {
            bzero (reg_has_output_reload, max_regno);
            CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_is_output_reload);

            find_reloads (insn, 1, spill_indirect_levels, live_known,
                      spill_reg_order);
          }

        if (n_reloads > 0)
          {
            rtx prev = PREV_INSN (insn), next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
            rtx p;
            int class;

            /* If this block has not had spilling done for a
             particular clas and we have any non-optionals that need a
             spill reg in that class, abort.  */

            for (class = 0; class < N_REG_CLASSES; class++)
            if (basic_block_needs[class] != 0
                && basic_block_needs[class][this_block] == 0)
              for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
                if (class == (int) reload_reg_class[i]
                  && reload_reg_rtx[i] == 0
                  && ! reload_optional[i]
                  && (reload_in[i] != 0 || reload_out[i] != 0
                      || reload_secondary_p[i] != 0))
                  fatal_insn ("Non-optional registers need a spill register", insn);

            /* Now compute which reload regs to reload them into.  Perhaps
             reusing reload regs from previous insns, or else output
             load insns to reload them.  Maybe output store insns too.
             Record the choices of reload reg in reload_reg_rtx.  */
            choose_reload_regs (insn, avoid_return_reg);

            /* Merge any reloads that we didn't combine for fear of 
             increasing the number of spill registers needed but now
             discover can be safely merged.  */
            if (SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES)
            merge_assigned_reloads (insn);

            /* Generate the insns to reload operands into or out of
             their reload regs.  */
            emit_reload_insns (insn);

            /* Substitute the chosen reload regs from reload_reg_rtx
             into the insn's body (or perhaps into the bodies of other
             load and store insn that we just made for reloading
             and that we moved the structure into).  */
            subst_reloads ();

            /* If this was an ASM, make sure that all the reload insns
             we have generated are valid.  If not, give an error
             and delete them.  */

            if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) >= 0)
            for (p = NEXT_INSN (prev); p != next; p = NEXT_INSN (p))
              if (p != insn && GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (p)) == 'i'
                  && (recog_memoized (p) < 0
                    || (insn_extract (p),
                        ! constrain_operands (INSN_CODE (p), 1))))
                {
                  error_for_asm (insn,
                             "`asm' operand requires impossible reload");
                  PUT_CODE (p, NOTE);
                  NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (p) = 0;
                  NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (p) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
                }
          }
        /* Any previously reloaded spilled pseudo reg, stored in this insn,
           is no longer validly lying around to save a future reload.
           Note that this does not detect pseudos that were reloaded
           for this insn in order to be stored in
           (obeying register constraints).  That is correct; such reload
           registers ARE still valid.  */
        note_stores (oldpat, forget_old_reloads_1);

        /* There may have been CLOBBER insns placed after INSN.  So scan
           between INSN and NEXT and use them to forget old reloads.  */
        for (x = NEXT_INSN (insn); x != next; x = NEXT_INSN (x))
          if (GET_CODE (x) == INSN && GET_CODE (PATTERN (x)) == CLOBBER)
            note_stores (PATTERN (x), forget_old_reloads_1);

#ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
        /* Likewise for regs altered by auto-increment in this insn.
           But note that the reg-notes are not changed by reloading:
           they still contain the pseudo-regs, not the spill regs.  */
        for (x = REG_NOTES (insn); x; x = XEXP (x, 1))
          if (REG_NOTE_KIND (x) == REG_INC)
            {
            /* See if this pseudo reg was reloaded in this insn.
               If so, its last-reload info is still valid
               because it is based on this insn's reload.  */
            for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
              if (reload_out[i] == XEXP (x, 0))
                break;

            if (i == n_reloads)
              forget_old_reloads_1 (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX);
            }
#endif
      }
      /* A reload reg's contents are unknown after a label.  */
      if (GET_CODE (insn) == CODE_LABEL)
      CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_valid);

      /* Don't assume a reload reg is still good after a call insn
       if it is a call-used reg.  */
      else if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
      AND_COMPL_HARD_REG_SET(reg_reloaded_valid, call_used_reg_set);

      /* In case registers overlap, allow certain insns to invalidate
       particular hard registers.  */

#ifdef INSN_CLOBBERS_REGNO_P
      for (i = 0 ; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i)
          && INSN_CLOBBERS_REGNO_P (insn, i))
        CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i);
#endif

      insn = next;

#ifdef USE_C_ALLOCA
      alloca (0);
#endif
    }
}

/* Discard all record of any value reloaded from X,
   or reloaded in X from someplace else;
   unless X is an output reload reg of the current insn.

   X may be a hard reg (the reload reg)
   or it may be a pseudo reg that was reloaded from.  */

static void
forget_old_reloads_1 (x, ignored)
     rtx x;
     rtx ignored ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
{
  register int regno;
  enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
  int nr;

  /* note_stores does give us subregs of hard regs.

     This is a egcs-1.1 tree hack only.  A better solution is being
     developed for mainline sources.  Do not import this back to the
     mainline tree.

     We want to strip all the SUBREGs, but also keep track of the
     largest mode we encounter so that we can invalidate all the
     hard regs which are needed to hold the widest mode.

     This avoids a bug in choose_reload_regs (which is where the real
     fix for the mainline tree will be).  */

  while (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG)
    {
      if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)) > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
      mode = GET_MODE (x);
      x = SUBREG_REG (x);
    }

  if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)) > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
    mode = GET_MODE (x);

  if (GET_CODE (x) != REG)
    return;

  regno = REGNO (x);

  if (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
    nr = 1;
  else
    {
      int i;
      nr = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, mode);
      /* Storing into a spilled-reg invalidates its contents.
       This can happen if a block-local pseudo is allocated to that reg
       and it wasn't spilled because this block's total need is 0.
       Then some insn might have an optional reload and use this reg.  */
      for (i = 0; i < nr; i++)
      /* But don't do this if the reg actually serves as an output
         reload reg in the current instruction.  */
      if (n_reloads == 0
          || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, regno + i))
        CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, regno + i);
    }

  /* Since value of X has changed,
     forget any value previously copied from it.  */

  while (nr-- > 0)
    /* But don't forget a copy if this is the output reload
       that establishes the copy's validity.  */
    if (n_reloads == 0 || reg_has_output_reload[regno + nr] == 0)
      reg_last_reload_reg[regno + nr] = 0;
}

/* For each reload, the mode of the reload register.  */
static enum machine_mode reload_mode[MAX_RELOADS];

/* For each reload, the largest number of registers it will require.  */
static int reload_nregs[MAX_RELOADS];

/* Comparison function for qsort to decide which of two reloads
   should be handled first.  *P1 and *P2 are the reload numbers.  */

static int
reload_reg_class_lower (r1p, r2p)
     const GENERIC_PTR r1p;
     const GENERIC_PTR r2p;
{
  register int r1 = *(short *)r1p, r2 = *(short *)r2p;
  register int t;

  /* Consider required reloads before optional ones.  */
  t = reload_optional[r1] - reload_optional[r2];
  if (t != 0)
    return t;

  /* Count all solitary classes before non-solitary ones.  */
  t = ((reg_class_size[(int) reload_reg_class[r2]] == 1)
       - (reg_class_size[(int) reload_reg_class[r1]] == 1));
  if (t != 0)
    return t;

  /* Aside from solitaires, consider all multi-reg groups first.  */
  t = reload_nregs[r2] - reload_nregs[r1];
  if (t != 0)
    return t;

  /* Consider reloads in order of increasing reg-class number.  */
  t = (int) reload_reg_class[r1] - (int) reload_reg_class[r2];
  if (t != 0)
    return t;

  /* If reloads are equally urgent, sort by reload number,
     so that the results of qsort leave nothing to chance.  */
  return r1 - r2;
}

/* The following HARD_REG_SETs indicate when each hard register is
   used for a reload of various parts of the current insn.  */

/* If reg is in use as a reload reg for a RELOAD_OTHER reload.  */
static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used;
/* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS reload for operand I.  */
static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
/* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS reload for operand I.  */
static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
/* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS reload for operand I.  */
static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
/* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS reload for operand I.  */
static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
/* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT reload for operand I.  */
static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_input[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
/* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reload for operand I.  */
static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_output[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
/* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reload.  */
static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_op_addr;
/* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR reload.  */
static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload;
/* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INSN reload.  */
static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_insn;
/* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS reload.  */
static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_other_addr;

/* If reg is in use as a reload reg for any sort of reload.  */
static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_at_all;

/* If reg is use as an inherited reload.  We just mark the first register
   in the group.  */
static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_for_inherit;

/* Mark reg REGNO as in use for a reload of the sort spec'd by OPNUM and
   TYPE. MODE is used to indicate how many consecutive regs are
   actually used.  */

static void
mark_reload_reg_in_use (regno, opnum, type, mode)
     int regno;
     int opnum;
     enum reload_type type;
     enum machine_mode mode;
{
  int nregs = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, mode);
  int i;

  for (i = regno; i < nregs + regno; i++)
    {
      switch (type)
      {
      case RELOAD_OTHER:
        SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, i);
        break;

      case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
        SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[opnum], i);
        break;

      case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
        SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[opnum], i);
        break;

      case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
        SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[opnum], i);
        break;

      case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
        SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[opnum], i);
        break;

      case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
        SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, i);
        break;

      case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
        SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, i);
        break;

      case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
        SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr, i);
        break;

      case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
        SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[opnum], i);
        break;

      case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
        SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[opnum], i);
        break;

      case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
        SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, i);
        break;
      }

      SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_at_all, i);
    }
}

/* Similarly, but show REGNO is no longer in use for a reload.  */

static void
clear_reload_reg_in_use (regno, opnum, type, mode)
     int regno;
     int opnum;
     enum reload_type type;
     enum machine_mode mode;
{
  int nregs = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, mode);
  int i;

  for (i = regno; i < nregs + regno; i++)
    {
      switch (type)
      {
      case RELOAD_OTHER:
        CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, i);
        break;

      case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
        CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[opnum], i);
        break;

      case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
        CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[opnum], i);
        break;

      case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
        CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[opnum], i);
        break;

      case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
        CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[opnum], i);
        break;

      case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
        CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, i);
        break;

      case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
        CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, i);
        break;

      case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
        CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr, i);
        break;

      case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
        CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[opnum], i);
        break;

      case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
        CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[opnum], i);
        break;

      case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
        CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, i);
        break;
      }
    }
}

/* 1 if reg REGNO is free as a reload reg for a reload of the sort
   specified by OPNUM and TYPE.  */

static int
reload_reg_free_p (regno, opnum, type)
     int regno;
     int opnum;
     enum reload_type type;
{
  int i;

  /* In use for a RELOAD_OTHER means it's not available for anything.  */
  if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno))
    return 0;

  switch (type)
    {
    case RELOAD_OTHER:
      /* In use for anything means we can't use it for RELOAD_OTHER.  */
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr, regno)
        || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno)
        || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno))
      return 0;

      for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
        return 0;

      return 1;

    case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
        || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno))
      return 0;

      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno))
      return 0;

      /* If it is used for some other input, can't use it.  */
      for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
        return 0;

      /* If it is used in a later operand's address, can't use it.  */
      for (i = opnum + 1; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno))
        return 0;

      return 1;

    case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
      /* Can't use a register if it is used for an input address for this
       operand or used as an input in an earlier one.  */
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[opnum], regno)
        || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[opnum], regno))
      return 0;

      for (i = 0; i < opnum; i++)
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
        return 0;

      return 1;

    case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
      /* Can't use a register if it is used for an input address
         for this operand or used as an input in an earlier
         one.  */
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[opnum], regno))
      return 0;

      for (i = 0; i < opnum; i++)
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
        return 0;

      return 1;

    case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
      /* Can't use a register if it is used for an output address for this
       operand or used as an output in this or a later operand.  */
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[opnum], regno))
      return 0;

      for (i = opnum; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
        return 0;

      return 1;

    case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
      /* Can't use a register if it is used for an output address
         for this operand or used as an output in this or a
         later operand.  */
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[opnum], regno))
      return 0;

      for (i = opnum; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
        return 0;

      return 1;

    case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
      for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
        return 0;

      return (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
            && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno));

    case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
      for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
        if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
          return 0;

      return (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno));

    case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
      /* This cannot share a register with RELOAD_FOR_INSN reloads, other
       outputs, or an operand address for this or an earlier output.  */
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno))
      return 0;

      for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
        return 0;

      for (i = 0; i <= opnum; i++)
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno))
        return 0;

      return 1;

    case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
      for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
        return 0;

      return (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
            && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno));

    case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
      return ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr, regno);
    }
  abort ();
}

/* Return 1 if the value in reload reg REGNO, as used by a reload
   needed for the part of the insn specified by OPNUM and TYPE,
   is not in use for a reload in any prior part of the insn.

   We can assume that the reload reg was already tested for availability
   at the time it is needed, and we should not check this again,
   in case the reg has already been marked in use.  */

static int
reload_reg_free_before_p (regno, opnum, type)
     int regno;
     int opnum;
     enum reload_type type;
{
  int i;

  switch (type)
    {
    case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
      /* These always come first.  */
      return 1;

    case RELOAD_OTHER:
      return ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr, regno);

      /* If this use is for part of the insn,
       check the reg is not in use for any prior part.  It is tempting
       to try to do this by falling through from objecs that occur
       later in the insn to ones that occur earlier, but that will not
       correctly take into account the fact that here we MUST ignore
       things that would prevent the register from being allocated in
       the first place, since we know that it was allocated.  */

    case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
      /* Earlier reloads include RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS reloads.  */
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[opnum], regno))
      return 0;
      /* ... fall through ...  */
    case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
      /* Earlier reloads are for earlier outputs or their addresses,
       any RELOAD_FOR_INSN reloads, any inputs or their addresses, or any
       RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS reloads (we know it can't conflict with
       RELOAD_OTHER)..  */
      for (i = 0; i < opnum; i++)
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
        return 0;

      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno))
      return 0;

      for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
        return 0;

      return (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr, regno)
            && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
            && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno)
            && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno));
                           
    case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
      /* There is no reason to call this function for output reloads, thus
       anything we'd put here wouldn't be tested.  So just abort.  */
       abort ();

    case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
      /* Earlier reloads include RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR reloads.  */
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno))
      return 0;

      /* ... fall through ...  */

    case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
    case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
      /* These can't conflict with inputs, or each other, so all we have to
       test is input addresses and the addresses of OTHER items.  */

      for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno))
        return 0;

      return ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr, regno);

    case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
      /* The only things earlier are the address for this and
       earlier inputs, other inputs (which we know we don't conflict
       with), and addresses of RELOAD_OTHER objects.  */

      for (i = 0; i <= opnum; i++)
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno))
        return 0;

      return ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr, regno);

    case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
      /* Earlier reloads include RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS reloads.  */
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[opnum], regno))
      return 0;
      /* ... fall through ...  */
    case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
      /* Similarly, all we have to check is for use in earlier inputs'
       addresses.  */
      for (i = 0; i < opnum; i++)
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno))
        return 0;

      return ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr, regno);
    }
  abort ();
}

/* Return 1 if the value in reload reg REGNO, as used by a reload
   needed for the part of the insn specified by OPNUM and TYPE,
   is still available in REGNO at the end of the insn.

   We can assume that the reload reg was already tested for availability
   at the time it is needed, and we should not check this again,
   in case the reg has already been marked in use.  */

static int
reload_reg_reaches_end_p (regno, opnum, type)
     int regno;
     int opnum;
     enum reload_type type;
{
  int i;

  switch (type)
    {
    case RELOAD_OTHER:
      /* Since a RELOAD_OTHER reload claims the reg for the entire insn,
       its value must reach the end.  */
      return 1;

      /* If this use is for part of the insn,
       its value reaches if no subsequent part uses the same register. 
       Just like the above function, don't try to do this with lots
       of fallthroughs.  */

    case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
      /* Here we check for everything else, since these don't conflict
       with anything else and everything comes later.  */

      for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
        return 0;

      return (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno)
            && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
            && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno));

    case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
    case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
      /* Similar, except that we check only for this and subsequent inputs
       and the address of only subsequent inputs and we do not need
       to check for RELOAD_OTHER objects since they are known not to
       conflict.  */

      for (i = opnum; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
        return 0;

      for (i = opnum + 1; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno))
        return 0;

      for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
        return 0;

      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno))
      return 0;

      return (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno)
            && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno));

    case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
      /* Similar to input address, except we start at the next operand for
       both input and input address and we do not check for 
       RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS and RELOAD_FOR_INSN since these
       would conflict.  */

      for (i = opnum + 1; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
        return 0;

      /* ... fall through ...  */

    case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
      /* Check outputs and their addresses.  */

      for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
        return 0;

      return 1;

    case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
      for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
        return 0;

      return (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno)
            && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno));

    case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
      /* These conflict with other outputs with RELOAD_OTHER.  So
       we need only check for output addresses.  */

      opnum = -1;

      /* ... fall through ...  */

    case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
    case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
    case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
      /* We already know these can't conflict with a later output.  So the
       only thing to check are later output addresses.  */
      for (i = opnum + 1; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
          || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno))
        return 0;

      return 1;
    }

  abort ();
}

/* Return 1 if the reloads denoted by R1 and R2 cannot share a register.
   Return 0 otherwise.

   This function uses the same algorithm as reload_reg_free_p above.  */

int
reloads_conflict (r1, r2)
     int r1, r2;
{
  enum reload_type r1_type = reload_when_needed[r1];
  enum reload_type r2_type = reload_when_needed[r2];
  int r1_opnum = reload_opnum[r1];
  int r2_opnum = reload_opnum[r2];

  /* RELOAD_OTHER conflicts with everything.  */
  if (r2_type == RELOAD_OTHER)
    return 1;

  /* Otherwise, check conflicts differently for each type.  */

  switch (r1_type)
    {
    case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
      return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INSN 
            || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
            || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR
            || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
            || ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
               || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS)
              && r2_opnum > r1_opnum));

    case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
      return ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS && r1_opnum == r2_opnum)
            || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT && r2_opnum < r1_opnum));

    case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
      return ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS && r1_opnum == r2_opnum)
            || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT && r2_opnum < r1_opnum));

    case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
      return ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS && r2_opnum == r1_opnum)
            || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT && r2_opnum >= r1_opnum));

    case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
      return ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS && r2_opnum == r1_opnum)
            || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT && r2_opnum >= r1_opnum));

    case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
      return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INSN
            || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS);

    case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
      return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT 
            || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR);

    case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
      return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INSN || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
            || ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS
               || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS)
              && r2_opnum >= r1_opnum));

    case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
      return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
            || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INSN
            || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS);

    case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
      return r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS;

    case RELOAD_OTHER:
      return 1;

    default:
      abort ();
    }
}

/* Vector of reload-numbers showing the order in which the reloads should
   be processed.  */
short reload_order[MAX_RELOADS];

/* Indexed by reload number, 1 if incoming value
   inherited from previous insns.  */
char reload_inherited[MAX_RELOADS];

/* For an inherited reload, this is the insn the reload was inherited from,
   if we know it.  Otherwise, this is 0.  */
rtx reload_inheritance_insn[MAX_RELOADS];

/* If non-zero, this is a place to get the value of the reload,
   rather than using reload_in.  */
rtx reload_override_in[MAX_RELOADS];

/* For each reload, the hard register number of the register used,
   or -1 if we did not need a register for this reload.  */
int reload_spill_index[MAX_RELOADS];

/* Return 1 if the value in reload reg REGNO, as used by a reload
   needed for the part of the insn specified by OPNUM and TYPE,
   may be used to load VALUE into it.

   Other read-only reloads with the same value do not conflict
   unless OUT is non-zero and these other reloads have to live while
   output reloads live.

   RELOADNUM is the number of the reload we want to load this value for;
   a reload does not conflict with itself.

   The caller has to make sure that there is no conflict with the return
   register.  */
static int
reload_reg_free_for_value_p (regno, opnum, type, value, out, reloadnum)
     int regno;
     int opnum;
     enum reload_type type;
     rtx value, out;
     int reloadnum;
{
  int time1;
  int i;

  /* We use some pseudo 'time' value to check if the lifetimes of the
     new register use would overlap with the one of a previous reload
     that is not read-only or uses a different value.
     The 'time' used doesn't have to be linear in any shape or form, just
     monotonic.
     Some reload types use different 'buckets' for each operand.
     So there are MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS different time values for each
     such reload type.
     We compute TIME1 as the time when the register for the prospective
     new reload ceases to be live, and TIME2 for each existing
     reload as the time when that the reload register of that reload
     becomes live.
     Where there is little to be gained by exact lifetime calculations,
     we just make conservative assumptions, i.e. a longer lifetime;
     this is done in the 'default:' cases.  */
  switch (type)
    {
    case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
      time1 = 0;
      break;
    /* For each input, we might have a sequence of RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS,
       RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS and RELOAD_FOR_INPUT.  By adding 0 / 1 / 2 ,
       respectively, to the time values for these, we get distinct time
       values.  To get distinct time values for each operand, we have to
       multiply opnum by at least three.  We round that up to four because
       multiply by four is often cheaper.  */
    case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
      time1 = opnum * 4 + 1;
      break;
    case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
      time1 = opnum * 4 + 2;
      break;
    case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
      /* All RELOAD_FOR_INPUT reloads remain live till just before the
       instruction is executed.  */
      time1 = (MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS - 1) * 4 + 3;
      break;
    /* opnum * 4 + 3 < opnum * 4 + 4
       <= (MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS - 1) * 4 + 4 == MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 */
    case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
      time1 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + opnum;
      break;
    default:
      time1 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 5;
    }

  for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
    {
      rtx reg = reload_reg_rtx[i];
      if (reg && GET_CODE (reg) == REG
        && ((unsigned) regno - true_regnum (reg)
            <= HARD_REGNO_NREGS (REGNO (reg), GET_MODE (reg)) - (unsigned)1)
        && i != reloadnum)
      {
        if (out
            && reload_when_needed[i] != RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
            && reload_when_needed[i] != RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
            && reload_when_needed[i] != RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS)
          return 0;
        if (! reload_in[i] || ! rtx_equal_p (reload_in[i], value)
            || reload_out[i])
          {
            int time2;
            switch (reload_when_needed[i])
            {
            case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
              time2 = 0;
              break;
            case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
              time2 = reload_opnum[i] * 4 + 1;
              break;
            case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
              time2 = reload_opnum[i] * 4 + 2;
              break;
            case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
              time2 = reload_opnum[i] * 4 + 3;
              break;
            case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
            /* All RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reloads become live just after the
               instruction is executed.  */
              time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4;
              break;
            /* The first RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS reload conflicts with the
               RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reloads, so assign it the same time value.  */
            case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
              time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + reload_opnum[i];
              break;
            case RELOAD_OTHER:
              if (! reload_in[i] || rtx_equal_p (reload_in[i], value))
                {
                  time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4;
                  break;
                }
            default:
              time2 = 0;
            }
            if (time1 >= time2)
            return 0;
          }
      }
    }
  return 1;
}

/* Find a spill register to use as a reload register for reload R.
   LAST_RELOAD is non-zero if this is the last reload for the insn being
   processed.

   Set reload_reg_rtx[R] to the register allocated.

   If NOERROR is nonzero, we return 1 if successful,
   or 0 if we couldn't find a spill reg and we didn't change anything.  */

static int
allocate_reload_reg (r, insn, last_reload, noerror)
     int r;
     rtx insn;
     int last_reload;
     int noerror;
{
  int i;
  int pass;
  int count;
  rtx new;
  int regno;

  /* If we put this reload ahead, thinking it is a group,
     then insist on finding a group.  Otherwise we can grab a
     reg that some other reload needs.
     (That can happen when we have a 68000 DATA_OR_FP_REG
     which is a group of data regs or one fp reg.)
     We need not be so restrictive if there are no more reloads
     for this insn.

     ??? Really it would be nicer to have smarter handling
     for that kind of reg class, where a problem like this is normal.
     Perhaps those classes should be avoided for reloading
     by use of more alternatives.  */

  int force_group = reload_nregs[r] > 1 && ! last_reload;

  /* If we want a single register and haven't yet found one,
     take any reg in the right class and not in use.
     If we want a consecutive group, here is where we look for it.

     We use two passes so we can first look for reload regs to
     reuse, which are already in use for other reloads in this insn,
     and only then use additional registers.
     I think that maximizing reuse is needed to make sure we don't
     run out of reload regs.  Suppose we have three reloads, and
     reloads A and B can share regs.  These need two regs.
     Suppose A and B are given different regs.
     That leaves none for C.  */
  for (pass = 0; pass < 2; pass++)
    {
      /* I is the index in spill_regs.
       We advance it round-robin between insns to use all spill regs
       equally, so that inherited reloads have a chance
       of leapfrogging each other.  Don't do this, however, when we have
       group needs and failure would be fatal; if we only have a relatively
       small number of spill registers, and more than one of them has
       group needs, then by starting in the middle, we may end up 
       allocating the first one in such a way that we are not left with
       sufficient groups to handle the rest.  */

      if (noerror || ! force_group)
      i = last_spill_reg;
      else
      i = -1;
        
      for (count = 0; count < n_spills; count++)
      {
        int class = (int) reload_reg_class[r];

        i = (i + 1) % n_spills;

        if ((reload_reg_free_p (spill_regs[i], reload_opnum[r],
                          reload_when_needed[r])
             || (reload_in[r]
                  /* We check reload_reg_used to make sure we
                   don't clobber the return register.  */
               && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, spill_regs[i])
               && reload_reg_free_for_value_p (spill_regs[i],
                                      reload_opnum[r],
                                      reload_when_needed[r],
                                      reload_in[r],
                                      reload_out[r], r)))
            && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[class], spill_regs[i])
            && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (spill_regs[i], reload_mode[r])
            /* Look first for regs to share, then for unshared.  But
             don't share regs used for inherited reloads; they are
             the ones we want to preserve.  */
            && (pass
              || (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_at_all,
                               spill_regs[i])
                  && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_for_inherit,
                                    spill_regs[i]))))
          {
            int nr = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (spill_regs[i], reload_mode[r]);
            /* Avoid the problem where spilling a GENERAL_OR_FP_REG
             (on 68000) got us two FP regs.  If NR is 1,
             we would reject both of them.  */
            if (force_group)
            nr = CLASS_MAX_NREGS (reload_reg_class[r], reload_mode[r]);
            /* If we need only one reg, we have already won.  */
            if (nr == 1)
            {
              /* But reject a single reg if we demand a group.  */
              if (force_group)
                continue;
              break;
            }
            /* Otherwise check that as many consecutive regs as we need
             are available here.
             Also, don't use for a group registers that are
             needed for nongroups.  */
            if (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (counted_for_nongroups, spill_regs[i]))
            while (nr > 1)
              {
                regno = spill_regs[i] + nr - 1;
                if (!(TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[class], regno)
                    && spill_reg_order[regno] >= 0
                    && reload_reg_free_p (regno, reload_opnum[r],
                                    reload_when_needed[r])
                    && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (counted_for_nongroups,
                                      regno)))
                  break;
                nr--;
              }
            if (nr == 1)
            break;
          }
      }

      /* If we found something on pass 1, omit pass 2.  */
      if (count < n_spills)
      break;
    }

  /* We should have found a spill register by now.  */
  if (count == n_spills)
    {
      if (noerror)
      return 0;
      goto failure;
    }

  /* I is the index in SPILL_REG_RTX of the reload register we are to
     allocate.  Get an rtx for it and find its register number.  */

  new = spill_reg_rtx[i];

  if (new == 0 || GET_MODE (new) != reload_mode[r])
    spill_reg_rtx[i] = new
      = gen_rtx_REG (reload_mode[r], spill_regs[i]);
          
  regno = true_regnum (new);

  /* Detect when the reload reg can't hold the reload mode.
     This used to be one `if', but Sequent compiler can't handle that.  */
  if (HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, reload_mode[r]))
    {
      enum machine_mode test_mode = VOIDmode;
      if (reload_in[r])
      test_mode = GET_MODE (reload_in[r]);
      /* If reload_in[r] has VOIDmode, it means we will load it
       in whatever mode the reload reg has: to wit, reload_mode[r].
       We have already tested that for validity.  */
      /* Aside from that, we need to test that the expressions
       to reload from or into have modes which are valid for this
       reload register.  Otherwise the reload insns would be invalid.  */
      if (! (reload_in[r] != 0 && test_mode != VOIDmode
           && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, test_mode)))
      if (! (reload_out[r] != 0
             && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, GET_MODE (reload_out[r]))))
        {
          /* The reg is OK.  */
          last_spill_reg = i;

          /* Mark as in use for this insn the reload regs we use
             for this.  */
          mark_reload_reg_in_use (spill_regs[i], reload_opnum[r],
                            reload_when_needed[r], reload_mode[r]);

          reload_reg_rtx[r] = new;
          reload_spill_index[r] = spill_regs[i];
          return 1;
        }
    }

  /* The reg is not OK.  */
  if (noerror)
    return 0;

 failure:
  if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) < 0)
    /* It's the compiler's fault.  */
    fatal_insn ("Could not find a spill register", insn);

  /* It's the user's fault; the operand's mode and constraint
     don't match.  Disable this reload so we don't crash in final.  */
  error_for_asm (insn,
             "`asm' operand constraint incompatible with operand size");
  reload_in[r] = 0;
  reload_out[r] = 0;
  reload_reg_rtx[r] = 0;
  reload_optional[r] = 1;
  reload_secondary_p[r] = 1;

  return 1;
}

/* Assign hard reg targets for the pseudo-registers we must reload
   into hard regs for this insn.
   Also output the instructions to copy them in and out of the hard regs.

   For machines with register classes, we are responsible for
   finding a reload reg in the proper class.  */

static void
choose_reload_regs (insn, avoid_return_reg)
     rtx insn;
     rtx avoid_return_reg;
{
  register int i, j;
  int max_group_size = 1;
  enum reg_class group_class = NO_REGS;
  int inheritance;

  rtx save_reload_reg_rtx[MAX_RELOADS];
  char save_reload_inherited[MAX_RELOADS];
  rtx save_reload_inheritance_insn[MAX_RELOADS];
  rtx save_reload_override_in[MAX_RELOADS];
  int save_reload_spill_index[MAX_RELOADS];
  HARD_REG_SET save_reload_reg_used;
  HARD_REG_SET save_reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
  HARD_REG_SET save_reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
  HARD_REG_SET save_reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
  HARD_REG_SET save_reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
  HARD_REG_SET save_reload_reg_used_in_input[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
  HARD_REG_SET save_reload_reg_used_in_output[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
  HARD_REG_SET save_reload_reg_used_in_op_addr;
  HARD_REG_SET save_reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload;
  HARD_REG_SET save_reload_reg_used_in_insn;
  HARD_REG_SET save_reload_reg_used_in_other_addr;
  HARD_REG_SET save_reload_reg_used_at_all;

  bzero (reload_inherited, MAX_RELOADS);
  bzero ((char *) reload_inheritance_insn, MAX_RELOADS * sizeof (rtx));
  bzero ((char *) reload_override_in, MAX_RELOADS * sizeof (rtx));

  CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used);
  CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_at_all);
  CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr);
  CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload);
  CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_insn);
  CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr);

  for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
    {
      CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_output[i]);
      CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_input[i]);
      CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i]);
      CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i]);
      CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i]);
      CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i]);
    }

  /* Don't bother with avoiding the return reg
     if we have no mandatory reload that could use it.  */
  if (SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES && avoid_return_reg)
    {
      int do_avoid = 0;
      int regno = REGNO (avoid_return_reg);
      int nregs
      = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, GET_MODE (avoid_return_reg));
      int r;

      for (r = regno; r < regno + nregs; r++)
      if (spill_reg_order[r] >= 0)
        for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
          if (!reload_optional[j] && reload_reg_rtx[j] == 0
            && (reload_in[j] != 0 || reload_out[j] != 0
                || reload_secondary_p[j])
            &&
            TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) reload_reg_class[j]], r))
            do_avoid = 1;
      if (!do_avoid)
      avoid_return_reg = 0;
    }

#if 0  /* Not needed, now that we can always retry without inheritance.  */
  /* See if we have more mandatory reloads than spill regs.
     If so, then we cannot risk optimizations that could prevent
     reloads from sharing one spill register.

     Since we will try finding a better register than reload_reg_rtx
     unless it is equal to reload_in or reload_out, count such reloads.  */

  {
    int tem = SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES? (avoid_return_reg != 0): 0;
    for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
      if (! reload_optional[j]
        && (reload_in[j] != 0 || reload_out[j] != 0 || reload_secondary_p[j])
        && (reload_reg_rtx[j] == 0
            || (! rtx_equal_p (reload_reg_rtx[j], reload_in[j])
              && ! rtx_equal_p (reload_reg_rtx[j], reload_out[j]))))
      tem++;
    if (tem > n_spills)
      must_reuse = 1;
  }
#endif

  /* Don't use the subroutine call return reg for a reload
     if we are supposed to avoid it.  */
  if (SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES && avoid_return_reg)
    {
      int regno = REGNO (avoid_return_reg);
      int nregs
      = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, GET_MODE (avoid_return_reg));
      int r;

      for (r = regno; r < regno + nregs; r++)
      if (spill_reg_order[r] >= 0)
        SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, r);
    }

  /* In order to be certain of getting the registers we need,
     we must sort the reloads into order of increasing register class.
     Then our grabbing of reload registers will parallel the process
     that provided the reload registers.

     Also note whether any of the reloads wants a consecutive group of regs.
     If so, record the maximum size of the group desired and what
     register class contains all the groups needed by this insn.  */

  for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
    {
      reload_order[j] = j;
      reload_spill_index[j] = -1;

      reload_mode[j]
      = (reload_inmode[j] == VOIDmode
         || (GET_MODE_SIZE (reload_outmode[j])
             > GET_MODE_SIZE (reload_inmode[j])))
        ? reload_outmode[j] : reload_inmode[j];

      reload_nregs[j] = CLASS_MAX_NREGS (reload_reg_class[j], reload_mode[j]);

      if (reload_nregs[j] > 1)
      {
        max_group_size = MAX (reload_nregs[j], max_group_size);
        group_class = reg_class_superunion[(int)reload_reg_class[j]][(int)group_class];
      }

      /* If we have already decided to use a certain register,
       don't use it in another way.  */
      if (reload_reg_rtx[j])
      mark_reload_reg_in_use (REGNO (reload_reg_rtx[j]), reload_opnum[j],
                        reload_when_needed[j], reload_mode[j]);
    }

  if (n_reloads > 1)
    qsort (reload_order, n_reloads, sizeof (short), reload_reg_class_lower);

  bcopy ((char *) reload_reg_rtx, (char *) save_reload_reg_rtx,
       sizeof reload_reg_rtx);
  bcopy (reload_inherited, save_reload_inherited, sizeof reload_inherited);
  bcopy ((char *) reload_inheritance_insn,
       (char *) save_reload_inheritance_insn,
       sizeof reload_inheritance_insn);
  bcopy ((char *) reload_override_in, (char *) save_reload_override_in,
       sizeof reload_override_in);
  bcopy ((char *) reload_spill_index, (char *) save_reload_spill_index,
       sizeof reload_spill_index);
  COPY_HARD_REG_SET (save_reload_reg_used, reload_reg_used);
  COPY_HARD_REG_SET (save_reload_reg_used_at_all, reload_reg_used_at_all);
  COPY_HARD_REG_SET (save_reload_reg_used_in_op_addr,
                 reload_reg_used_in_op_addr);

  COPY_HARD_REG_SET (save_reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload,
                 reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload);

  COPY_HARD_REG_SET (save_reload_reg_used_in_insn,
                 reload_reg_used_in_insn);
  COPY_HARD_REG_SET (save_reload_reg_used_in_other_addr,
                 reload_reg_used_in_other_addr);

  for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
    {
      COPY_HARD_REG_SET (save_reload_reg_used_in_output[i],
                   reload_reg_used_in_output[i]);
      COPY_HARD_REG_SET (save_reload_reg_used_in_input[i],
                   reload_reg_used_in_input[i]);
      COPY_HARD_REG_SET (save_reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i],
                   reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i]);
      COPY_HARD_REG_SET (save_reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i],
                   reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i]);
      COPY_HARD_REG_SET (save_reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i],
                   reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i]);
      COPY_HARD_REG_SET (save_reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i],
                   reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i]);
    }

  /* If -O, try first with inheritance, then turning it off.
     If not -O, don't do inheritance.
     Using inheritance when not optimizing leads to paradoxes
     with fp on the 68k: fp numbers (not NaNs) fail to be equal to themselves
     because one side of the comparison might be inherited.  */

  for (inheritance = optimize > 0; inheritance >= 0; inheritance--)
    {
      /* Process the reloads in order of preference just found.
       Beyond this point, subregs can be found in reload_reg_rtx.

       This used to look for an existing reloaded home for all
       of the reloads, and only then perform any new reloads.
       But that could lose if the reloads were done out of reg-class order
       because a later reload with a looser constraint might have an old
       home in a register needed by an earlier reload with a tighter constraint.

       To solve this, we make two passes over the reloads, in the order
       described above.  In the first pass we try to inherit a reload
       from a previous insn.  If there is a later reload that needs a
       class that is a proper subset of the class being processed, we must
       also allocate a spill register during the first pass.

       Then make a second pass over the reloads to allocate any reloads
       that haven't been given registers yet.  */

      CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_for_inherit);

      for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
      {
        register int r = reload_order[j];

        /* Ignore reloads that got marked inoperative.  */
        if (reload_out[r] == 0 && reload_in[r] == 0
            && ! reload_secondary_p[r])
          continue;

        /* If find_reloads chose a to use reload_in or reload_out as a reload
           register, we don't need to chose one.  Otherwise, try even if it
           found one since we might save an insn if we find the value lying
           around.  */
        if (reload_in[r] != 0 && reload_reg_rtx[r] != 0
            && (rtx_equal_p (reload_in[r], reload_reg_rtx[r])
              || rtx_equal_p (reload_out[r], reload_reg_rtx[r])))
          continue;

#if 0 /* No longer needed for correct operation.
       It might give better code, or might not; worth an experiment?  */
        /* If this is an optional reload, we can't inherit from earlier insns
           until we are sure that any non-optional reloads have been allocated.
           The following code takes advantage of the fact that optional reloads
           are at the end of reload_order.  */
        if (reload_optional[r] != 0)
          for (i = 0; i < j; i++)
            if ((reload_out[reload_order[i]] != 0
               || reload_in[reload_order[i]] != 0
               || reload_secondary_p[reload_order[i]])
              && ! reload_optional[reload_order[i]]
              && reload_reg_rtx[reload_order[i]] == 0)
            allocate_reload_reg (reload_order[i], insn, 0, inheritance);
#endif

        /* First see if this pseudo is already available as reloaded
           for a previous insn.  We cannot try to inherit for reloads
           that are smaller than the maximum number of registers needed
           for groups unless the register we would allocate cannot be used
           for the groups.

           We could check here to see if this is a secondary reload for
           an object that is already in a register of the desired class.
           This would avoid the need for the secondary reload register.
           But this is complex because we can't easily determine what
           objects might want to be loaded via this reload.  So let a
           register be allocated here.  In `emit_reload_insns' we suppress
           one of the loads in the case described above.  */

        if (inheritance)
          {
            register int regno = -1;
            enum machine_mode mode;

            if (reload_in[r] == 0)
            ;
            else if (GET_CODE (reload_in[r]) == REG)
            {
              regno = REGNO (reload_in[r]);
              mode = GET_MODE (reload_in[r]);
            }
            else if (GET_CODE (reload_in_reg[r]) == REG)
            {
              regno = REGNO (reload_in_reg[r]);
              mode = GET_MODE (reload_in_reg[r]);
            }
            else if (GET_CODE (reload_in[r]) == MEM)
            {
              rtx prev = prev_nonnote_insn (insn), note;

              if (prev && GET_CODE (prev) == INSN
                  && GET_CODE (PATTERN (prev)) == USE
                  && GET_CODE (XEXP (PATTERN (prev), 0)) == REG
                  && (REGNO (XEXP (PATTERN (prev), 0))
                    >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
                  && (note = find_reg_note (prev, REG_EQUAL, NULL_RTX))
                  && GET_CODE (XEXP (note, 0)) == MEM)
                {
                  rtx addr = XEXP (XEXP (note, 0), 0);
                  int size_diff
                  = (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (addr))
                     - GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (reload_in[r])));
                  if (size_diff >= 0
                    && rtx_equal_p ((BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
                                 ? plus_constant (addr, size_diff)
                                 : addr),
                                XEXP (reload_in[r], 0)))
                  {
                    regno = REGNO (XEXP (PATTERN (prev), 0));
                    mode = GET_MODE (reload_in[r]);
                  }
                }
            }
#if 0
            /* This won't work, since REGNO can be a pseudo reg number.
             Also, it takes much more hair to keep track of all the things
             that can invalidate an inherited reload of part of a pseudoreg.  */
            else if (GET_CODE (reload_in[r]) == SUBREG
                   && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (reload_in[r])) == REG)
            regno = REGNO (SUBREG_REG (reload_in[r])) + SUBREG_WORD (reload_in[r]);
#endif

            if (regno >= 0 && reg_last_reload_reg[regno] != 0)
            {
              i = REGNO (reg_last_reload_reg[regno]);

              if (reg_reloaded_contents[i] == regno
                  && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i)
                  && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (reg_last_reload_reg[regno]))
                    >= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
                  && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (i, reload_mode[r])
                  && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) reload_reg_class[r]],
                                  i)
                  && (reload_nregs[r] == max_group_size
                    || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) group_class],
                                      i))
                  && ((reload_reg_free_p (i, reload_opnum[r],
                                    reload_when_needed[r])
                     && reload_reg_free_before_p (i, reload_opnum[r],
                                          reload_when_needed[r]))
                    || reload_reg_free_for_value_p (i, reload_opnum[r],
                                            reload_when_needed[r],
                                            reload_in[r],
                                            reload_out[r], r)))
                {
                  /* If a group is needed, verify that all the subsequent
                   registers still have their values intact.  */
                  int nr
                  = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (i, reload_mode[r]);
                  int k;

                  for (k = 1; k < nr; k++)
                  if (reg_reloaded_contents[i + k] != regno
                      || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i + k))
                    break;

                  if (k == nr)
                  {
                    int i1;

                    /* We found a register that contains the
                       value we need.  If this register is the
                       same as an `earlyclobber' operand of the
                       current insn, just mark it as a place to
                       reload from since we can't use it as the
                       reload register itself.  */

                    for (i1 = 0; i1 < n_earlyclobbers; i1++)
                      if (reg_overlap_mentioned_for_reload_p
                        (reg_last_reload_reg[regno],
                         reload_earlyclobbers[i1]))
                        break;

                    if (i1 != n_earlyclobbers
                        /* Don't use it if we'd clobber a pseudo reg.  */
                        || (spill_reg_order[i] < 0
                          && reload_out[r]
                          && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead, i))
                        /* Don't really use the inherited spill reg
                         if we need it wider than we've got it.  */
                        || (GET_MODE_SIZE (reload_mode[r])
                          > GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)))
                      reload_override_in[r] = reg_last_reload_reg[regno];
                    else
                      {
                        int k;
                        /* We can use this as a reload reg.  */
                        /* Mark the register as in use for this part of
                         the insn.  */
                        mark_reload_reg_in_use (i,
                                          reload_opnum[r],
                                          reload_when_needed[r],
                                          reload_mode[r]);
                        reload_reg_rtx[r] = reg_last_reload_reg[regno];
                        reload_inherited[r] = 1;
                        reload_inheritance_insn[r]
                        = reg_reloaded_insn[i];
                        reload_spill_index[r] = i;
                        for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
                        SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_for_inherit,
                                      i + k);
                      }
                  }
                }
            }
          }

        /* Here's another way to see if the value is already lying around.  */
        if (inheritance
            && reload_in[r] != 0
            && ! reload_inherited[r]
            && reload_out[r] == 0
            && (CONSTANT_P (reload_in[r])
              || GET_CODE (reload_in[r]) == PLUS
              || GET_CODE (reload_in[r]) == REG
              || GET_CODE (reload_in[r]) == MEM)
            && (reload_nregs[r] == max_group_size
              || ! reg_classes_intersect_p (reload_reg_class[r], group_class)))
          {
            register rtx equiv
            = find_equiv_reg (reload_in[r], insn, reload_reg_class[r],
                          -1, NULL_PTR, 0, reload_mode[r]);
            int regno;

            if (equiv != 0)
            {
              if (GET_CODE (equiv) == REG)
                regno = REGNO (equiv);
              else if (GET_CODE (equiv) == SUBREG)
                {
                  /* This must be a SUBREG of a hard register.
                   Make a new REG since this might be used in an
                   address and not all machines support SUBREGs
                   there.  */
                  regno = REGNO (SUBREG_REG (equiv)) + SUBREG_WORD (equiv);
                  equiv = gen_rtx_REG (reload_mode[r], regno);
                }
              else
                abort ();
            }

            /* If we found a spill reg, reject it unless it is free
             and of the desired class.  */
            if (equiv != 0
              && ((spill_reg_order[regno] >= 0
                   && ! (reload_reg_free_before_p (regno, reload_opnum[r],
                                           reload_when_needed[r])
                       || reload_reg_free_for_value_p (regno,
                                               reload_opnum[r],
                                               reload_when_needed[r],
                                               reload_in[r],
                                               reload_out[r], r)))
                  || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) reload_reg_class[r]],
                                    regno)))
            equiv = 0;

            if (equiv != 0 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_at_all, regno))
            equiv = 0;

            if (equiv != 0 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, reload_mode[r]))
            equiv = 0;

            /* We found a register that contains the value we need.
             If this register is the same as an `earlyclobber' operand
             of the current insn, just mark it as a place to reload from
             since we can't use it as the reload register itself.  */

            if (equiv != 0)
            for (i = 0; i < n_earlyclobbers; i++)
              if (reg_overlap_mentioned_for_reload_p (equiv,
                                            reload_earlyclobbers[i]))
                {
                  reload_override_in[r] = equiv;
                  equiv = 0;
                  break;
                }

            /* If the equiv register we have found is explicitly clobbered
             in the current insn, it depends on the reload type if we
             can use it, use it for reload_override_in, or not at all.
             In particular, we then can't use EQUIV for a
             RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS reload.  */

            if (equiv != 0 && regno_clobbered_p (regno, insn))
            {
              switch (reload_when_needed[r])
                {
                case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
                case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
                case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
                case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
                  break;
                case RELOAD_OTHER:
                case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
                case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
                  reload_override_in[r] = equiv;
                  /* Fall through. */
                default:
                  equiv = 0;
                  break;
                }
            }

            /* If we found an equivalent reg, say no code need be generated
             to load it, and use it as our reload reg.  */
            if (equiv != 0 && regno != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
            {
              int nr = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, reload_mode[r]);
              int k;
              reload_reg_rtx[r] = equiv;
              reload_inherited[r] = 1;

              /* If reg_reloaded_valid is not set for this register,
                 there might be a stale spill_reg_store lying around.
                 We must clear it, since otherwise emit_reload_insns
                 might delete the store.  */
              if (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, regno))
                spill_reg_store[regno] = NULL_RTX;
              /* If any of the hard registers in EQUIV are spill
                 registers, mark them as in use for this insn.  */
              for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
                {
                  i = spill_reg_order[regno + k];
                  if (i >= 0)
                  {
                    mark_reload_reg_in_use (regno, reload_opnum[r],
                                      reload_when_needed[r],
                                      reload_mode[r]);
                    SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_for_inherit,
                                  regno + k);
                  }
                }
            }
          }

        /* If we found a register to use already, or if this is an optional
           reload, we are done.  */
        if (reload_reg_rtx[r] != 0 || reload_optional[r] != 0)
          continue;

#if 0 /* No longer needed for correct operation.  Might or might not
       give better code on the average.  Want to experiment?  */

        /* See if there is a later reload that has a class different from our
           class that intersects our class or that requires less register
           than our reload.  If so, we must allocate a register to this
           reload now, since that reload might inherit a previous reload
           and take the only available register in our class.  Don't do this
           for optional reloads since they will force all previous reloads
           to be allocated.  Also don't do this for reloads that have been
           turned off.  */

        for (i = j + 1; i < n_reloads; i++)
          {
            int s = reload_order[i];

            if ((reload_in[s] == 0 && reload_out[s] == 0
               && ! reload_secondary_p[s])
              || reload_optional[s])
            continue;

            if ((reload_reg_class[s] != reload_reg_class[r]
               && reg_classes_intersect_p (reload_reg_class[r],
                                     reload_reg_class[s]))
              || reload_nregs[s] < reload_nregs[r])
            break;
          }

        if (i == n_reloads)
          continue;

        allocate_reload_reg (r, insn, j == n_reloads - 1, inheritance);
#endif
      }

      /* Now allocate reload registers for anything non-optional that
       didn't get one yet.  */
      for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
      {
        register int r = reload_order[j];

        /* Ignore reloads that got marked inoperative.  */
        if (reload_out[r] == 0 && reload_in[r] == 0 && ! reload_secondary_p[r])
          continue;

        /* Skip reloads that already have a register allocated or are
           optional.  */
        if (reload_reg_rtx[r] != 0 || reload_optional[r])
          continue;

        if (! allocate_reload_reg (r, insn, j == n_reloads - 1, inheritance))
          break;
      }

      /* If that loop got all the way, we have won.  */
      if (j == n_reloads)
      break;

    fail:
      /* Loop around and try without any inheritance.  */
      /* First undo everything done by the failed attempt
       to allocate with inheritance.  */
      bcopy ((char *) save_reload_reg_rtx, (char *) reload_reg_rtx,
           sizeof reload_reg_rtx);
      bcopy ((char *) save_reload_inherited, (char *) reload_inherited,
           sizeof reload_inherited);
      bcopy ((char *) save_reload_inheritance_insn,
           (char *) reload_inheritance_insn,
           sizeof reload_inheritance_insn);
      bcopy ((char *) save_reload_override_in, (char *) reload_override_in,
           sizeof reload_override_in);
      bcopy ((char *) save_reload_spill_index, (char *) reload_spill_index,
           sizeof reload_spill_index);
      COPY_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used, save_reload_reg_used);
      COPY_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_at_all, save_reload_reg_used_at_all);
      COPY_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr,
                   save_reload_reg_used_in_op_addr);
      COPY_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload,
                   save_reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload);
      COPY_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_insn,
                   save_reload_reg_used_in_insn);
      COPY_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr,
                   save_reload_reg_used_in_other_addr);

      for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
      {
        COPY_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_input[i],
                       save_reload_reg_used_in_input[i]);
        COPY_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_output[i],
                       save_reload_reg_used_in_output[i]);
        COPY_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i],
                       save_reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i]);
        COPY_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i],
                       save_reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i]);
        COPY_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i],
                       save_reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i]);
        COPY_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i],
                       save_reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i]);
      }
    }

  /* If we thought we could inherit a reload, because it seemed that
     nothing else wanted the same reload register earlier in the insn,
     verify that assumption, now that all reloads have been assigned.  */

  for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
    {
      register int r = reload_order[j];

      if (reload_inherited[r] && reload_reg_rtx[r] != 0
        && ! (reload_reg_free_before_p (true_regnum (reload_reg_rtx[r]),
                                reload_opnum[r],
                                reload_when_needed[r])
            || reload_reg_free_for_value_p (true_regnum (reload_reg_rtx[r]),
                                    reload_opnum[r],
                                    reload_when_needed[r],
                                    reload_in[r],
                                    reload_out[r], r)))
      reload_inherited[r] = 0;
      /* If we can inherit a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT, then we do not need its related
       RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS / RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS reloads.
       ??? This could be extended to other reload types, but these are
         more tricky to handle:
       RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS reloads might have been merged, so we
       can't eliminate them without a check that *all* references are
       now unused due to inheritance.
       While RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS and RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS are
       not merged, we can't be sure that we have eliminated the use of
       that particular reload if we have seen just one
       RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS / RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS being inherited,
       since there might be multiple of the latter two reloads for a single
       operand.
       RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR reloads for different operands are not
       merged, but might share the same register by courtesy of
       reload_reg_free_for_value_p.  reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload
       does not differentiate by opnum, thus calling clear_reload_reg_in_use
       for one of these reloads would mark the register as free even though
       another RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR reload might still use it.  */
      else if (reload_inherited[r] && reload_when_needed[r] == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT)
      {
        for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
          {
            if ((reload_when_needed[i] == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
               || reload_when_needed[i] == RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS)
              && reload_opnum[i] == reload_opnum[r]
              && reload_in[i] && reload_reg_rtx[i])
            {
              int regno = true_regnum (reload_reg_rtx[i]);

              reload_in[i] = 0;
              if (spill_reg_order[regno] >= 0)
                clear_reload_reg_in_use (regno, reload_opnum[i],
                                   reload_when_needed[i],
                                   reload_mode[i]);
              reload_reg_rtx[i] = 0;
              reload_spill_index[i] = -1;
              remove_replacements (i);
            }
          }
      }

      /* If we found a better place to reload from,
       validate it in the same fashion, if it is a reload reg.  */
      if (reload_override_in[r]
        && (GET_CODE (reload_override_in[r]) == REG
            || GET_CODE (reload_override_in[r]) == SUBREG))
      {
        int regno = true_regnum (reload_override_in[r]);
        if (spill_reg_order[regno] >= 0
            && ! reload_reg_free_before_p (regno, reload_opnum[r],
                                   reload_when_needed[r]))
          reload_override_in[r] = 0;
      }
    }

  /* Now that reload_override_in is known valid,
     actually override reload_in.  */
  for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
    if (reload_override_in[j])
      reload_in[j] = reload_override_in[j];

  /* If this reload won't be done because it has been cancelled or is
     optional and not inherited, clear reload_reg_rtx so other
     routines (such as subst_reloads) don't get confused.  */
  for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
    if (reload_reg_rtx[j] != 0
      && ((reload_optional[j] && ! reload_inherited[j])
          || (reload_in[j] == 0 && reload_out[j] == 0
            && ! reload_secondary_p[j])))
      {
      int regno = true_regnum (reload_reg_rtx[j]);

      if (spill_reg_order[regno] >= 0)
        clear_reload_reg_in_use (regno, reload_opnum[j],
                           reload_when_needed[j], reload_mode[j]);
      reload_reg_rtx[j] = 0;
      }

  /* Record which pseudos and which spill regs have output reloads.  */
  for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
    {
      register int r = reload_order[j];

      i = reload_spill_index[r];

      /* I is nonneg if this reload uses a register.
       If reload_reg_rtx[r] is 0, this is an optional reload
       that we opted to ignore.  */
      if (reload_out[r] != 0 && GET_CODE (reload_out[r]) == REG
        && reload_reg_rtx[r] != 0)
      {
        register int nregno = REGNO (reload_out[r]);
        int nr = 1;

        if (nregno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
          nr = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (nregno, reload_mode[r]);

        while (--nr >= 0)
          reg_has_output_reload[nregno + nr] = 1;

        if (i >= 0)
          {
            nr = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (i, reload_mode[r]);
            while (--nr >= 0)
            SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, i + nr);
          }

        if (reload_when_needed[r] != RELOAD_OTHER
            && reload_when_needed[r] != RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
            && reload_when_needed[r] != RELOAD_FOR_INSN)
          abort ();
      }
    }
}

/* If SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES is non-zero, we may not have merged two
   reloads of the same item for fear that we might not have enough reload
   registers. However, normally they will get the same reload register
   and hence actually need not be loaded twice.  

   Here we check for the most common case of this phenomenon: when we have
   a number of reloads for the same object, each of which were allocated
   the same reload_reg_rtx, that reload_reg_rtx is not used for any other
   reload, and is not modified in the insn itself.  If we find such,
   merge all the reloads and set the resulting reload to RELOAD_OTHER.
   This will not increase the number of spill registers needed and will
   prevent redundant code.  */

static void
merge_assigned_reloads (insn)
     rtx insn;
{
  int i, j;

  /* Scan all the reloads looking for ones that only load values and
     are not already RELOAD_OTHER and ones whose reload_reg_rtx are
     assigned and not modified by INSN.  */

  for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
    {
      int conflicting_input = 0;
      int max_input_address_opnum = -1;
      int min_conflicting_input_opnum = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS;

      if (reload_in[i] == 0 || reload_when_needed[i] == RELOAD_OTHER
        || reload_out[i] != 0 || reload_reg_rtx[i] == 0
        || reg_set_p (reload_reg_rtx[i], insn))
      continue;

      /* Look at all other reloads.  Ensure that the only use of this
       reload_reg_rtx is in a reload that just loads the same value
       as we do.  Note that any secondary reloads must be of the identical
       class since the values, modes, and result registers are the
       same, so we need not do anything with any secondary reloads.  */

      for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
      {
        if (i == j || reload_reg_rtx[j] == 0
            || ! reg_overlap_mentioned_p (reload_reg_rtx[j],
                                  reload_reg_rtx[i]))
          continue;

        if (reload_when_needed[j] == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
            && reload_opnum[j] > max_input_address_opnum)
          max_input_address_opnum = reload_opnum[j];

        /* If the reload regs aren't exactly the same (e.g, different modes)
           or if the values are different, we can't merge this reload.
           But if it is an input reload, we might still merge
           RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS and RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS reloads.  */

        if (! rtx_equal_p (reload_reg_rtx[i], reload_reg_rtx[j])
            || reload_out[j] != 0 || reload_in[j] == 0
            || ! rtx_equal_p (reload_in[i], reload_in[j]))
          {
            if (reload_when_needed[j] != RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
              || ((reload_when_needed[i] != RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
                   || reload_opnum[i] > reload_opnum[j])
                  && reload_when_needed[i] != RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS))
            break;
            conflicting_input = 1;
            if (min_conflicting_input_opnum > reload_opnum[j])
            min_conflicting_input_opnum = reload_opnum[j];
          }
      }

      /* If all is OK, merge the reloads.  Only set this to RELOAD_OTHER if
       we, in fact, found any matching reloads.  */

      if (j == n_reloads
        && max_input_address_opnum <= min_conflicting_input_opnum)
      {
        for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
          if (i != j && reload_reg_rtx[j] != 0
            && rtx_equal_p (reload_reg_rtx[i], reload_reg_rtx[j])
            && (! conflicting_input
                || reload_when_needed[j] == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
                || reload_when_needed[j] == RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS))
            {
            reload_when_needed[i] = RELOAD_OTHER;
            reload_in[j] = 0;
            reload_spill_index[j] = -1;
            transfer_replacements (i, j);
            }

        /* If this is now RELOAD_OTHER, look for any reloads that load
           parts of this operand and set them to RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS
           if they were for inputs, RELOAD_OTHER for outputs.  Note that
           this test is equivalent to looking for reloads for this operand
           number.  */

        if (reload_when_needed[i] == RELOAD_OTHER)
          for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
            if (reload_in[j] != 0
              && reload_when_needed[i] != RELOAD_OTHER
              && reg_overlap_mentioned_for_reload_p (reload_in[j],
                                           reload_in[i]))
            reload_when_needed[j]
              = ((reload_when_needed[i] == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
                  || reload_when_needed[i] == RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS)
                 ? RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS : RELOAD_OTHER);
      }
    }
}         


/* Output insns to reload values in and out of the chosen reload regs.  */

static void
emit_reload_insns (insn)
     rtx insn;
{
  register int j;
  rtx input_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
  rtx other_input_address_reload_insns = 0;
  rtx other_input_reload_insns = 0;
  rtx input_address_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
  rtx inpaddr_address_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
  rtx output_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
  rtx output_address_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
  rtx outaddr_address_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
  rtx operand_reload_insns = 0;
  rtx other_operand_reload_insns = 0;
  rtx other_output_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
  rtx following_insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
  rtx before_insn = insn;
  int special;
  /* Values to be put in spill_reg_store are put here first.  */
  rtx new_spill_reg_store[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
  HARD_REG_SET reg_reloaded_died;

  CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_died);

  for (j = 0; j < reload_n_operands; j++)
    input_reload_insns[j] = input_address_reload_insns[j]
      = inpaddr_address_reload_insns[j]
      = output_reload_insns[j] = output_address_reload_insns[j]
      = outaddr_address_reload_insns[j]
      = other_output_reload_insns[j] = 0;

  /* Now output the instructions to copy the data into and out of the
     reload registers.  Do these in the order that the reloads were reported,
     since reloads of base and index registers precede reloads of operands
     and the operands may need the base and index registers reloaded.  */

  for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
    {
      register rtx old;
      rtx oldequiv_reg = 0;
      rtx this_reload_insn = 0;
      int expect_occurrences = 1;

      if (reload_spill_index[j] >= 0)
      new_spill_reg_store[reload_spill_index[j]] = 0;

      old = reload_in[j];
      if (old != 0 && ! reload_inherited[j]
        && ! rtx_equal_p (reload_reg_rtx[j], old)
        && reload_reg_rtx[j] != 0)
      {
        register rtx reloadreg = reload_reg_rtx[j];
        rtx oldequiv = 0;
        enum machine_mode mode;
        rtx *where;

        /* Determine the mode to reload in.
           This is very tricky because we have three to choose from.
           There is the mode the insn operand wants (reload_inmode[J]).
           There is the mode of the reload register RELOADREG.
           There is the intrinsic mode of the operand, which we could find
           by stripping some SUBREGs.
           It turns out that RELOADREG's mode is irrelevant:
           we can change that arbitrarily.

           Consider (SUBREG:SI foo:QI) as an operand that must be SImode;
           then the reload reg may not support QImode moves, so use SImode.
           If foo is in memory due to spilling a pseudo reg, this is safe,
           because the QImode value is in the least significant part of a
           slot big enough for a SImode.  If foo is some other sort of
           memory reference, then it is impossible to reload this case,
           so previous passes had better make sure this never happens.

           Then consider a one-word union which has SImode and one of its
           members is a float, being fetched as (SUBREG:SF union:SI).
           We must fetch that as SFmode because we could be loading into
           a float-only register.  In this case OLD's mode is correct.

           Consider an immediate integer: it has VOIDmode.  Here we need
           to get a mode from something else.

           In some cases, there is a fourth mode, the operand's
           containing mode.  If the insn specifies a containing mode for
           this operand, it overrides all others.

           I am not sure whether the algorithm here is always right,
           but it does the right things in those cases.  */

        mode = GET_MODE (old);
        if (mode == VOIDmode)
          mode = reload_inmode[j];

#ifdef SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
        /* If we need a secondary register for this operation, see if
           the value is already in a register in that class.  Don't
           do this if the secondary register will be used as a scratch
           register.  */

        if (reload_secondary_in_reload[j] >= 0
            && reload_secondary_in_icode[j] == CODE_FOR_nothing
            && optimize)
          oldequiv
            = find_equiv_reg (old, insn,
                        reload_reg_class[reload_secondary_in_reload[j]],
                        -1, NULL_PTR, 0, mode);
#endif

        /* If reloading from memory, see if there is a register
           that already holds the same value.  If so, reload from there.
           We can pass 0 as the reload_reg_p argument because
           any other reload has either already been emitted,
           in which case find_equiv_reg will see the reload-insn,
           or has yet to be emitted, in which case it doesn't matter
           because we will use this equiv reg right away.  */

        if (oldequiv == 0 && optimize
            && (GET_CODE (old) == MEM
              || (GET_CODE (old) == REG
                  && REGNO (old) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
                  && reg_renumber[REGNO (old)] < 0)))
          oldequiv = find_equiv_reg (old, insn, ALL_REGS,
                               -1, NULL_PTR, 0, mode);

        if (oldequiv)
          {
            int regno = true_regnum (oldequiv);

            /* If OLDEQUIV is a spill register, don't use it for this
             if any other reload needs it at an earlier stage of this insn
             or at this stage.  */
            if (spill_reg_order[regno] >= 0
              && (! reload_reg_free_p (regno, reload_opnum[j],
                                 reload_when_needed[j])
                  || ! reload_reg_free_before_p (regno, reload_opnum[j],
                                         reload_when_needed[j])))
            oldequiv = 0;

            /* If OLDEQUIV is not a spill register,
             don't use it if any other reload wants it.  */
            if (spill_reg_order[regno] < 0)
            {
              int k;
              for (k = 0; k < n_reloads; k++)
                if (reload_reg_rtx[k] != 0 && k != j
                  && reg_overlap_mentioned_for_reload_p (reload_reg_rtx[k],
                                                 oldequiv))
                  {
                  oldequiv = 0;
                  break;
                  }
            }

            /* If it is no cheaper to copy from OLDEQUIV into the
             reload register than it would be to move from memory,
             don't use it. Likewise, if we need a secondary register
             or memory.   */

            if (oldequiv != 0
              && ((REGNO_REG_CLASS (regno) != reload_reg_class[j]
                   && (REGISTER_MOVE_COST (REGNO_REG_CLASS (regno),
                                     reload_reg_class[j])
                     >= MEMORY_MOVE_COST (mode, reload_reg_class[j], 1)))
#ifdef SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
                  || (SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (reload_reg_class[j],
                                          mode, oldequiv)
                    != NO_REGS)
#endif
#ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
                  || SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (REGNO_REG_CLASS (regno),
                                      reload_reg_class[j],
                                      mode)
#endif
                  ))
            oldequiv = 0;
          }

        if (oldequiv == 0)
          oldequiv = old;
        else if (GET_CODE (oldequiv) == REG)
          oldequiv_reg = oldequiv;
        else if (GET_CODE (oldequiv) == SUBREG)
          oldequiv_reg = SUBREG_REG (oldequiv);

        /* If we are reloading from a register that was recently stored in
           with an output-reload, see if we can prove there was
           actually no need to store the old value in it.  */

        if (optimize && GET_CODE (oldequiv) == REG
            && REGNO (oldequiv) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
            && spill_reg_store[REGNO (oldequiv)]
            && GET_CODE (old) == REG && dead_or_set_p (insn, old)
            /* This is unsafe if operand occurs more than once in current
             insn.  Perhaps some occurrences weren't reloaded.  */
            && count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn), old) == 1)
          delete_output_reload (insn, j, spill_reg_store[REGNO (oldequiv)]);

        /* Encapsulate both RELOADREG and OLDEQUIV into that mode,
           then load RELOADREG from OLDEQUIV.  Note that we cannot use
           gen_lowpart_common since it can do the wrong thing when
           RELOADREG has a multi-word mode.  Note that RELOADREG
           must always be a REG here.  */

        if (GET_MODE (reloadreg) != mode)
          reloadreg = gen_rtx_REG (mode, REGNO (reloadreg));
        while (GET_CODE (oldequiv) == SUBREG && GET_MODE (oldequiv) != mode)
          oldequiv = SUBREG_REG (oldequiv);
        if (GET_MODE (oldequiv) != VOIDmode
            && mode != GET_MODE (oldequiv))
          oldequiv = gen_rtx_SUBREG (mode, oldequiv, 0);

        /* Switch to the right place to emit the reload insns.  */
        switch (reload_when_needed[j])
          {
          case RELOAD_OTHER:
            where = &other_input_reload_insns;
            break;
          case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
            where = &input_reload_insns[reload_opnum[j]];
            break;
          case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
            where = &input_address_reload_insns[reload_opnum[j]];
            break;
          case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
            where = &inpaddr_address_reload_insns[reload_opnum[j]];
            break;
          case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
            where = &output_address_reload_insns[reload_opnum[j]];
            break;
          case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
            where = &outaddr_address_reload_insns[reload_opnum[j]];
            break;
          case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
            where = &operand_reload_insns;
            break;
          case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
            where = &other_operand_reload_insns;
            break;
          case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
            where = &other_input_address_reload_insns;
            break;
          default:
            abort ();
          }

        push_to_sequence (*where);
        special = 0;

        /* Auto-increment addresses must be reloaded in a special way.  */
        if (GET_CODE (oldequiv) == POST_INC
            || GET_CODE (oldequiv) == POST_DEC
            || GET_CODE (oldequiv) == PRE_INC
            || GET_CODE (oldequiv) == PRE_DEC)
          {
            /* We are not going to bother supporting the case where a
             incremented register can't be copied directly from
             OLDEQUIV since this seems highly unlikely.  */
            if (reload_secondary_in_reload[j] >= 0)
            abort ();
            /* Prevent normal processing of this reload.  */
            special = 1;
            /* Output a special code sequence for this case.  */
            inc_for_reload (reloadreg, oldequiv, reload_inc[j]);
          }

        /* If we are reloading a pseudo-register that was set by the previous
           insn, see if we can get rid of that pseudo-register entirely
           by redirecting the previous insn into our reload register.  */

        else if (optimize && GET_CODE (old) == REG
               && REGNO (old) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
               && dead_or_set_p (insn, old)
               /* This is unsafe if some other reload
                  uses the same reg first.  */
               && reload_reg_free_before_p (REGNO (reloadreg),
                                    reload_opnum[j],
                                    reload_when_needed[j]))
          {
            rtx temp = PREV_INSN (insn);
            while (temp && GET_CODE (temp) == NOTE)
            temp = PREV_INSN (temp);
            if (temp
              && GET_CODE (temp) == INSN
              && GET_CODE (PATTERN (temp)) == SET
              && SET_DEST (PATTERN (temp)) == old
              /* Make sure we can access insn_operand_constraint.  */
              && asm_noperands (PATTERN (temp)) < 0
              /* This is unsafe if prev insn rejects our reload reg.  */
              && constraint_accepts_reg_p (insn_operand_constraint[recog_memoized (temp)][0],
                                     reloadreg)
              /* This is unsafe if operand occurs more than once in current
                 insn.  Perhaps some occurrences aren't reloaded.  */
              && count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn), old) == 1
              /* Don't risk splitting a matching pair of operands.  */
              && ! reg_mentioned_p (old, SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp))))
            {
              /* Store into the reload register instead of the pseudo.  */
              SET_DEST (PATTERN (temp)) = reloadreg;
              /* If these are the only uses of the pseudo reg,
                 pretend for GDB it lives in the reload reg we used.  */
              if (REG_N_DEATHS (REGNO (old)) == 1
                  && REG_N_SETS (REGNO (old)) == 1)
                {
                  reg_renumber[REGNO (old)] = REGNO (reload_reg_rtx[j]);
                  alter_reg (REGNO (old), -1);
                }
              special = 1;
            }
          }

        /* We can't do that, so output an insn to load RELOADREG.  */

        if (! special)
          {
#ifdef SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
            rtx second_reload_reg = 0;
            enum insn_code icode;

            /* If we have a secondary reload, pick up the secondary register
             and icode, if any.  If OLDEQUIV and OLD are different or
             if this is an in-out reload, recompute whether or not we
             still need a secondary register and what the icode should
             be.  If we still need a secondary register and the class or
             icode is different, go back to reloading from OLD if using
             OLDEQUIV means that we got the wrong type of register.  We
             cannot have different class or icode due to an in-out reload
             because we don't make such reloads when both the input and
             output need secondary reload registers.  */

            if (reload_secondary_in_reload[j] >= 0)
            {
              int secondary_reload = reload_secondary_in_reload[j];
              rtx real_oldequiv = oldequiv;
              rtx real_old = old;

              /* If OLDEQUIV is a pseudo with a MEM, get the real MEM
                 and similarly for OLD.
                 See comments in get_secondary_reload in reload.c.  */
              if (GET_CODE (oldequiv) == REG
                  && REGNO (oldequiv) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
                  && reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (oldequiv)] != 0)
                real_oldequiv = reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (oldequiv)];

              if (GET_CODE (old) == REG
                  && REGNO (old) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
                  && reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (old)] != 0)
                real_old = reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (old)];

              second_reload_reg = reload_reg_rtx[secondary_reload];
              icode = reload_secondary_in_icode[j];

              if ((old != oldequiv && ! rtx_equal_p (old, oldequiv))
                  || (reload_in[j] != 0 && reload_out[j] != 0))
                {
                  enum reg_class new_class
                  = SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (reload_reg_class[j],
                                          mode, real_oldequiv);

                  if (new_class == NO_REGS)
                  second_reload_reg = 0;
                  else
                  {
                    enum insn_code new_icode;
                    enum machine_mode new_mode;

                    if (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) new_class],
                                       REGNO (second_reload_reg)))
                      oldequiv = old, real_oldequiv = real_old;
                    else
                      {
                        new_icode = reload_in_optab[(int) mode];
                        if (new_icode != CODE_FOR_nothing
                          && ((insn_operand_predicate[(int) new_icode][0]
                               && ! ((*insn_operand_predicate[(int) new_icode][0])
                                   (reloadreg, mode)))
                              || (insn_operand_predicate[(int) new_icode][1]
                                && ! ((*insn_operand_predicate[(int) new_icode][1])
                                    (real_oldequiv, mode)))))
                        new_icode = CODE_FOR_nothing;

                        if (new_icode == CODE_FOR_nothing)
                        new_mode = mode;
                        else
                        new_mode = insn_operand_mode[(int) new_icode][2];

                        if (GET_MODE (second_reload_reg) != new_mode)
                        {
                          if (!HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (REGNO (second_reload_reg),
                                             new_mode))
                            oldequiv = old, real_oldequiv = real_old;
                          else
                            second_reload_reg
                              = gen_rtx_REG (new_mode,
                                         REGNO (second_reload_reg));
                        }
                      }
                  }
                }

              /* If we still need a secondary reload register, check
                 to see if it is being used as a scratch or intermediate
                 register and generate code appropriately.  If we need
                 a scratch register, use REAL_OLDEQUIV since the form of
                 the insn may depend on the actual address if it is 
                 a MEM.  */

              if (second_reload_reg)
                {
                  if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
                  {
                    emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode) (reloadreg, real_oldequiv,
                                          second_reload_reg));
                    special = 1;
                  }
                  else
                  {
                    /* See if we need a scratch register to load the
                       intermediate register (a tertiary reload).  */
                    enum insn_code tertiary_icode
                      = reload_secondary_in_icode[secondary_reload];

                    if (tertiary_icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
                      {
                        rtx third_reload_reg
                          = reload_reg_rtx[reload_secondary_in_reload[secondary_reload]];

                        emit_insn ((GEN_FCN (tertiary_icode)
                                (second_reload_reg, real_oldequiv,
                                 third_reload_reg)));
                      }
                    else
                      gen_reload (second_reload_reg, oldequiv,
                              reload_opnum[j],
                              reload_when_needed[j]);

                    oldequiv = second_reload_reg;
                  }
                }
            }
#endif

            if (! special && ! rtx_equal_p (reloadreg, oldequiv))
            gen_reload (reloadreg, oldequiv, reload_opnum[j],
                      reload_when_needed[j]);

#if defined(SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS) && defined(PRESERVE_DEATH_INFO_REGNO_P)
            /* We may have to make a REG_DEAD note for the secondary reload
             register in the insns we just made.  Find the last insn that
             mentioned the register.  */
            if (! special && second_reload_reg
              && PRESERVE_DEATH_INFO_REGNO_P (REGNO (second_reload_reg)))
            {
              rtx prev;

              for (prev = get_last_insn (); prev;
                   prev = PREV_INSN (prev))
                if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (prev) == 'i')
                  && reg_overlap_mentioned_for_reload_p (second_reload_reg,
                                                 PATTERN (prev)))
                  {
                  REG_NOTES (prev) = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_DEAD,
                                                second_reload_reg,
                                                REG_NOTES (prev));
                  break;
                  }
            }
#endif
          }

        this_reload_insn = get_last_insn ();
        /* End this sequence.  */
        *where = get_insns ();
        end_sequence ();
      }

      /* When inheriting a wider reload, we have a MEM in reload_in[j],
       e.g. inheriting a SImode output reload for
       (mem:HI (plus:SI (reg:SI 14 fp) (const_int 10)))  */
      if (optimize && reload_inherited[j] && reload_in[j]
        && GET_CODE (reload_in[j]) == MEM
        && reload_spill_index[j] >= 0
        && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, reload_spill_index[j]))
      {
        expect_occurrences
          = count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn), reload_in[j]) == 1 ? 0 : -1;
        reload_in[j]
          = regno_reg_rtx[reg_reloaded_contents[reload_spill_index[j]]];
      }
      /* Add a note saying the input reload reg
       dies in this insn, if anyone cares.  */
#ifdef PRESERVE_DEATH_INFO_REGNO_P
      if (old != 0
        && reload_reg_rtx[j] != old
        && reload_reg_rtx[j] != 0
        && reload_out[j] == 0
        && ! reload_inherited[j]
        && PRESERVE_DEATH_INFO_REGNO_P (REGNO (reload_reg_rtx[j])))
      {
        register rtx reloadreg = reload_reg_rtx[j];

#if 0
        /* We can't abort here because we need to support this for sched.c.
           It's not terrible to miss a REG_DEAD note, but we should try
           to figure out how to do this correctly.  */
        /* The code below is incorrect for address-only reloads.  */
        if (reload_when_needed[j] != RELOAD_OTHER
            && reload_when_needed[j] != RELOAD_FOR_INPUT)
          abort ();
#endif

        /* Add a death note to this insn, for an input reload.  */

        if ((reload_when_needed[j] == RELOAD_OTHER
             || reload_when_needed[j] == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT)
            && ! dead_or_set_p (insn, reloadreg))
          REG_NOTES (insn)
            = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_DEAD,
                           reloadreg, REG_NOTES (insn));
      }

      /* When we inherit a reload, the last marked death of the reload reg
       may no longer really be a death.  */
      if (reload_reg_rtx[j] != 0
        && PRESERVE_DEATH_INFO_REGNO_P (REGNO (reload_reg_rtx[j]))
        && reload_inherited[j])
      {
        /* Handle inheriting an output reload.
           Remove the death note from the output reload insn.  */
        if (reload_spill_index[j] >= 0
            && GET_CODE (reload_in[j]) == REG
            && spill_reg_store[reload_spill_index[j]] != 0
            && find_regno_note (spill_reg_store[reload_spill_index[j]],
                          REG_DEAD, REGNO (reload_reg_rtx[j])))
          remove_death (REGNO (reload_reg_rtx[j]),
                    spill_reg_store[reload_spill_index[j]]);
        /* Likewise for input reloads that were inherited.  */
        else if (reload_spill_index[j] >= 0
               && GET_CODE (reload_in[j]) == REG
               && spill_reg_store[reload_spill_index[j]] == 0
               && reload_inheritance_insn[j] != 0
               && find_regno_note (reload_inheritance_insn[j], REG_DEAD,
                               REGNO (reload_reg_rtx[j])))
          remove_death (REGNO (reload_reg_rtx[j]),
                    reload_inheritance_insn[j]);
        else
          {
            rtx prev;

            /* We got this register from find_equiv_reg.
             Search back for its last death note and get rid of it.
             But don't search back too far.
             Don't go past a place where this reg is set,
             since a death note before that remains valid.  */
            for (prev = PREV_INSN (insn);
               prev && GET_CODE (prev) != CODE_LABEL;
               prev = PREV_INSN (prev))
            if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (prev)) == 'i'
                && dead_or_set_p (prev, reload_reg_rtx[j]))
              {
                if (find_regno_note (prev, REG_DEAD,
                               REGNO (reload_reg_rtx[j])))
                  remove_death (REGNO (reload_reg_rtx[j]), prev);
                break;
              }
          }
      }

      /* We might have used find_equiv_reg above to choose an alternate
       place from which to reload.  If so, and it died, we need to remove
       that death and move it to one of the insns we just made.  */

      if (oldequiv_reg != 0
        && PRESERVE_DEATH_INFO_REGNO_P (true_regnum (oldequiv_reg)))
      {
        rtx prev, prev1;

        for (prev = PREV_INSN (insn); prev && GET_CODE (prev) != CODE_LABEL;
             prev = PREV_INSN (prev))
          if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (prev)) == 'i'
            && dead_or_set_p (prev, oldequiv_reg))
            {
            if (find_regno_note (prev, REG_DEAD, REGNO (oldequiv_reg)))
              {
                for (prev1 = this_reload_insn;
                   prev1; prev1 = PREV_INSN (prev1))
                  if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (prev1) == 'i')
                  && reg_overlap_mentioned_for_reload_p (oldequiv_reg,
                                                 PATTERN (prev1)))
                  {
                  REG_NOTES (prev1) = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_DEAD,
                                                 oldequiv_reg,
                                                 REG_NOTES (prev1));
                  break;
                  }
                remove_death (REGNO (oldequiv_reg), prev);
              }
            break;
            }
      }
#endif

      /* If we are reloading a register that was recently stored in with an
       output-reload, see if we can prove there was
       actually no need to store the old value in it.  */

      if (optimize && reload_inherited[j] && reload_spill_index[j] >= 0
        && reload_in[j] != 0
        && GET_CODE (reload_in[j]) == REG
#if 0
        /* There doesn't seem to be any reason to restrict this to pseudos
           and doing so loses in the case where we are copying from a
           register of the wrong class.  */
        && REGNO (reload_in[j]) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
#endif
        && spill_reg_store[reload_spill_index[j]] != 0
        /* This is unsafe if some other reload uses the same reg first.  */
        && reload_reg_free_before_p (reload_spill_index[j],
                               reload_opnum[j], reload_when_needed[j])
        && dead_or_set_p (insn, reload_in[j])
        /* This is unsafe if operand occurs more than once in current
           insn.  Perhaps some occurrences weren't reloaded.  */
        && (count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn), reload_in[j])
            == expect_occurrences))
      delete_output_reload (insn, j,
                        spill_reg_store[reload_spill_index[j]]);

      /* Input-reloading is done.  Now do output-reloading,
       storing the value from the reload-register after the main insn
       if reload_out[j] is nonzero.

       ??? At some point we need to support handling output reloads of
       JUMP_INSNs or insns that set cc0.  */
      old = reload_out[j];
      if (old != 0
        && reload_reg_rtx[j] != old
        && reload_reg_rtx[j] != 0)
      {
        register rtx reloadreg = reload_reg_rtx[j];
#ifdef SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
        register rtx second_reloadreg = 0;
#endif
        rtx note, p;
        enum machine_mode mode;
        int special = 0;

        /* An output operand that dies right away does need a reload,
           but need not be copied from it.  Show the new location in the
           REG_UNUSED note.  */
        if ((GET_CODE (old) == REG || GET_CODE (old) == SCRATCH)
            && (note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_UNUSED, old)) != 0)
          {
            XEXP (note, 0) = reload_reg_rtx[j];
            continue;
          }
        /* Likewise for a SUBREG of an operand that dies.  */
        else if (GET_CODE (old) == SUBREG
               && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (old)) == REG
               && 0 != (note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_UNUSED,
                                      SUBREG_REG (old))))
          {
            XEXP (note, 0) = gen_lowpart_common (GET_MODE (old),
                                       reload_reg_rtx[j]);
            continue;
          }
        else if (GET_CODE (old) == SCRATCH)
          /* If we aren't optimizing, there won't be a REG_UNUSED note,
             but we don't want to make an output reload.  */
          continue;

#if 0
        /* Strip off of OLD any size-increasing SUBREGs such as
           (SUBREG:SI foo:QI 0).  */

        while (GET_CODE (old) == SUBREG && SUBREG_WORD (old) == 0
             && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (old))
                 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (old)))))
          old = SUBREG_REG (old);
#endif

        /* If is a JUMP_INSN, we can't support output reloads yet.  */
        if (GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN)
          abort ();

        if (reload_when_needed[j] == RELOAD_OTHER)
          start_sequence ();
        else
          push_to_sequence (output_reload_insns[reload_opnum[j]]);

        /* Determine the mode to reload in.
           See comments above (for input reloading).  */

        mode = GET_MODE (old);
        if (mode == VOIDmode)
          {
            /* VOIDmode should never happen for an output.  */
            if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) < 0)
            /* It's the compiler's fault.  */
            fatal_insn ("VOIDmode on an output", insn);
            error_for_asm (insn, "output operand is constant in `asm'");
            /* Prevent crash--use something we know is valid.  */
            mode = word_mode;
            old = gen_rtx_REG (mode, REGNO (reloadreg));
          }

        if (GET_MODE (reloadreg) != mode)
          reloadreg = gen_rtx_REG (mode, REGNO (reloadreg));

#ifdef SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS

        /* If we need two reload regs, set RELOADREG to the intermediate
           one, since it will be stored into OLD.  We might need a secondary
           register only for an input reload, so check again here.  */

        if (reload_secondary_out_reload[j] >= 0)
          {
            rtx real_old = old;

            if (GET_CODE (old) == REG && REGNO (old) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
              && reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (old)] != 0)
            real_old = reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (old)];

            if((SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (reload_reg_class[j],
                                     mode, real_old)
              != NO_REGS))
            {
              second_reloadreg = reloadreg;
              reloadreg = reload_reg_rtx[reload_secondary_out_reload[j]];

              /* See if RELOADREG is to be used as a scratch register
                 or as an intermediate register.  */
              if (reload_secondary_out_icode[j] != CODE_FOR_nothing)
                {
                  emit_insn ((GEN_FCN (reload_secondary_out_icode[j])
                          (real_old, second_reloadreg, reloadreg)));
                  special = 1;
                }
              else
                {
                  /* See if we need both a scratch and intermediate reload
                   register.  */

                  int secondary_reload = reload_secondary_out_reload[j];
                  enum insn_code tertiary_icode
                  = reload_secondary_out_icode[secondary_reload];

                  if (GET_MODE (reloadreg) != mode)
                  reloadreg = gen_rtx_REG (mode, REGNO (reloadreg));

                  if (tertiary_icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
                  {
                    rtx third_reloadreg
                      = reload_reg_rtx[reload_secondary_out_reload[secondary_reload]];
                    rtx tem;

                    /* Copy primary reload reg to secondary reload reg.
                       (Note that these have been swapped above, then
                       secondary reload reg to OLD using our insn.  */

                    /* If REAL_OLD is a paradoxical SUBREG, remove it
                       and try to put the opposite SUBREG on
                       RELOADREG.  */
                    if (GET_CODE (real_old) == SUBREG
                        && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (real_old))
                          > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (real_old))))
                        && 0 != (tem = gen_lowpart_common
                               (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (real_old)),
                              reloadreg)))
                      real_old = SUBREG_REG (real_old), reloadreg = tem;

                    gen_reload (reloadreg, second_reloadreg,
                              reload_opnum[j], reload_when_needed[j]);
                    emit_insn ((GEN_FCN (tertiary_icode)
                              (real_old, reloadreg, third_reloadreg)));
                    special = 1;
                  }

                  else
                  /* Copy between the reload regs here and then to
                     OUT later.  */

                  gen_reload (reloadreg, second_reloadreg,
                            reload_opnum[j], reload_when_needed[j]);
                }
            }
          }
#endif

        /* Output the last reload insn.  */
        if (! special)
          {
            rtx set;

            /* Don't output the last reload if OLD is not the dest of
             INSN and is in the src and is clobbered by INSN. */
            if (! flag_expensive_optimizations
              || GET_CODE (old) != REG
              || !(set = single_set (insn))
              || rtx_equal_p (old, SET_DEST (set))
              || !reg_mentioned_p (old, SET_SRC (set))
              || !regno_clobbered_p (REGNO (old), insn))
            gen_reload (old, reloadreg, reload_opnum[j],
                      reload_when_needed[j]);
          }

#ifdef PRESERVE_DEATH_INFO_REGNO_P
        /* If final will look at death notes for this reg,
           put one on the last output-reload insn to use it.  Similarly
           for any secondary register.  */
        if (PRESERVE_DEATH_INFO_REGNO_P (REGNO (reloadreg)))
          for (p = get_last_insn (); p; p = PREV_INSN (p))
            if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (p)) == 'i'
              && reg_overlap_mentioned_for_reload_p (reloadreg,
                                           PATTERN (p)))
            REG_NOTES (p) = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_DEAD,
                                       reloadreg, REG_NOTES (p));

#ifdef SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
        if (! special && second_reloadreg
            && PRESERVE_DEATH_INFO_REGNO_P (REGNO (second_reloadreg)))
          for (p = get_last_insn (); p; p = PREV_INSN (p))
            if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (p)) == 'i'
              && reg_overlap_mentioned_for_reload_p (second_reloadreg,
                                           PATTERN (p)))
            REG_NOTES (p) = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_DEAD,
                                       second_reloadreg,
                                       REG_NOTES (p));
#endif
#endif
        /* Look at all insns we emitted, just to be safe.  */
        for (p = get_insns (); p; p = NEXT_INSN (p))
          if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (p)) == 'i')
            {
            rtx pat = PATTERN (p);

            /* If this output reload doesn't come from a spill reg,
               clear any memory of reloaded copies of the pseudo reg.
               If this output reload comes from a spill reg,
               reg_has_output_reload will make this do nothing.  */
            note_stores (pat, forget_old_reloads_1);

            if (reg_mentioned_p (reload_reg_rtx[j], pat))
              {
                if (reload_spill_index[j] < 0
                  && GET_CODE (pat) == SET
                  && SET_SRC (pat) == reload_reg_rtx[j])
                  {
                  int src = REGNO (SET_SRC (pat));

                  reload_spill_index[j] = src;
                  SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, src);
                  if (find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, src))
                    SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_died, src);
                  }
                if (reload_spill_index[j] >= 0)
                  {
                  int s = reload_secondary_out_reload[j];
                  rtx set = single_set (p);
                  /* If this reload copies only to the secondary reload
                     register, the secondary reload does the actual
                     store.  */
                  if (s >= 0 && set == NULL_RTX)
                    ; /* We can't tell what function the secondary reload
                         has and where the actual store to the pseudo is
                         made; leave new_spill_reg_store alone.  */
                  else if (s >= 0
                      && SET_SRC (set) == reload_reg_rtx[j]
                      && SET_DEST (set) == reload_reg_rtx[s])
                    {
                      /* Usually the next instruction will be the
                         secondary reload insn;  if we can confirm
                         that it is, setting new_spill_reg_store to
                         that insn will allow an extra optimization.  */
                      rtx s_reg = reload_reg_rtx[s];
                      rtx next = NEXT_INSN (p);
                      reload_out[s] = reload_out[j];
                      set = single_set (next);
                      if (set && SET_SRC (set) == s_reg
                        && ! new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (s_reg)])
                        new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (s_reg)] = next;
                    }
                  else
                    new_spill_reg_store[reload_spill_index[j]] = p;
                  }
              }
            }

        if (reload_when_needed[j] == RELOAD_OTHER)
          {
            emit_insns (other_output_reload_insns[reload_opnum[j]]);
            other_output_reload_insns[reload_opnum[j]] = get_insns ();
          }
        else
          output_reload_insns[reload_opnum[j]] = get_insns ();

        end_sequence ();
      }
    }

  /* Now write all the insns we made for reloads in the order expected by
     the allocation functions.  Prior to the insn being reloaded, we write
     the following reloads:

     RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS reloads for input addresses.

     RELOAD_OTHER reloads.

     For each operand, any RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS reloads followed
     by any RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS reloads followed by the
     RELOAD_FOR_INPUT reload for the operand.

     RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDRS reloads.

     RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reloads.

     After the insn being reloaded, we write the following:

     For each operand, any RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS reloads followed
     by any RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS reload followed by the
     RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reload, followed by any RELOAD_OTHER output
     reloads for the operand.  The RELOAD_OTHER output reloads are
     output in descending order by reload number.  */

  emit_insns_before (other_input_address_reload_insns, before_insn);
  emit_insns_before (other_input_reload_insns, before_insn);

  for (j = 0; j < reload_n_operands; j++)
    {
      emit_insns_before (inpaddr_address_reload_insns[j], before_insn);
      emit_insns_before (input_address_reload_insns[j], before_insn);
      emit_insns_before (input_reload_insns[j], before_insn);
    }

  emit_insns_before (other_operand_reload_insns, before_insn);
  emit_insns_before (operand_reload_insns, before_insn);

  for (j = 0; j < reload_n_operands; j++)
    {
      emit_insns_before (outaddr_address_reload_insns[j], following_insn);
      emit_insns_before (output_address_reload_insns[j], following_insn);
      emit_insns_before (output_reload_insns[j], following_insn);
      emit_insns_before (other_output_reload_insns[j], following_insn);
    }

  /* Move death notes from INSN
     to output-operand-address and output reload insns.  */
#ifdef PRESERVE_DEATH_INFO_REGNO_P
  {
    rtx insn1;
    /* Loop over those insns, last ones first.  */
    for (insn1 = PREV_INSN (following_insn); insn1 != insn;
       insn1 = PREV_INSN (insn1))
      if (GET_CODE (insn1) == INSN && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn1)) == SET)
      {
        rtx source = SET_SRC (PATTERN (insn1));
        rtx dest = SET_DEST (PATTERN (insn1));

        /* The note we will examine next.  */
        rtx reg_notes = REG_NOTES (insn);
        /* The place that pointed to this note.  */
        rtx *prev_reg_note = &REG_NOTES (insn);

        /* If the note is for something used in the source of this
           reload insn, or in the output address, move the note.  */
        while (reg_notes)
          {
            rtx next_reg_notes = XEXP (reg_notes, 1);
            if (REG_NOTE_KIND (reg_notes) == REG_DEAD
              && GET_CODE (XEXP (reg_notes, 0)) == REG
              && ((GET_CODE (dest) != REG
                   && reg_overlap_mentioned_for_reload_p (XEXP (reg_notes, 0),
                                                dest))
                  || reg_overlap_mentioned_for_reload_p (XEXP (reg_notes, 0),
                                               source)))
            {
              *prev_reg_note = next_reg_notes;
              XEXP (reg_notes, 1) = REG_NOTES (insn1);
              REG_NOTES (insn1) = reg_notes;
            }
            else
            prev_reg_note = &XEXP (reg_notes, 1);

            reg_notes = next_reg_notes;
          }
      }
  }
#endif

  /* For all the spill regs newly reloaded in this instruction,
     record what they were reloaded from, so subsequent instructions
     can inherit the reloads.

     Update spill_reg_store for the reloads of this insn.
     Copy the elements that were updated in the loop above.  */

  for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
    {
      register int r = reload_order[j];
      register int i = reload_spill_index[r];

      /* I is nonneg if this reload used a register.
       If reload_reg_rtx[r] is 0, this is an optional reload
       that we opted to ignore.  */

      if (i >= 0 && reload_reg_rtx[r] != 0)
      {
        int nr
          = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (i, GET_MODE (reload_reg_rtx[r]));
        int k;
        int part_reaches_end = 0;
        int all_reaches_end = 1;

        /* For a multi register reload, we need to check if all or part
           of the value lives to the end.  */
        for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
          {
            if (reload_reg_reaches_end_p (i + k, reload_opnum[r],
                                  reload_when_needed[r]))
            part_reaches_end = 1;
            else
            all_reaches_end = 0;
          }

        /* Ignore reloads that don't reach the end of the insn in
           entirety.  */
        if (all_reaches_end)
          {
            /* First, clear out memory of what used to be in this spill reg.
             If consecutive registers are used, clear them all.  */

            for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
            CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i + k);

            /* Maybe the spill reg contains a copy of reload_out.  */
            if (reload_out[r] != 0 && GET_CODE (reload_out[r]) == REG)
            {
              register int nregno = REGNO (reload_out[r]);
              int nnr = (nregno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER ? 1
                       : HARD_REGNO_NREGS (nregno,
                                     GET_MODE (reload_reg_rtx[r])));

              spill_reg_store[i] = new_spill_reg_store[i];
              reg_last_reload_reg[nregno] = reload_reg_rtx[r];

              /* If NREGNO is a hard register, it may occupy more than
                 one register.  If it does, say what is in the 
                 rest of the registers assuming that both registers
                 agree on how many words the object takes.  If not,
                 invalidate the subsequent registers.  */

              if (nregno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
                for (k = 1; k < nnr; k++)
                  reg_last_reload_reg[nregno + k]
                  = (nr == nnr
                     ? gen_rtx_REG (reg_raw_mode[REGNO (reload_reg_rtx[r]) + k],
                                REGNO (reload_reg_rtx[r]) + k)
                     : 0);

              /* Now do the inverse operation.  */
              for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
                {
                  CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead, i + k);
                  reg_reloaded_contents[i + k]
                  = (nregno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER || nr != nnr
                     ? nregno
                     : nregno + k);
                  reg_reloaded_insn[i + k] = insn;
                  SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i + k);
                }
            }

            /* Maybe the spill reg contains a copy of reload_in.  Only do
             something if there will not be an output reload for
             the register being reloaded.  */
            else if (reload_out[r] == 0
                   && reload_in[r] != 0
                   && spill_reg_order[i] >= 0
                   && ((GET_CODE (reload_in[r]) == REG
                      && ! reg_has_output_reload[REGNO (reload_in[r])])
                     || (GET_CODE (reload_in_reg[r]) == REG
                         && ! reg_has_output_reload[REGNO (reload_in_reg[r])])))
            {
              register int nregno;
              int nnr;

              if (GET_CODE (reload_in[r]) == REG)
                nregno = REGNO (reload_in[r]);
              else
                nregno = REGNO (reload_in_reg[r]);

              nnr = (nregno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER ? 1
                   : HARD_REGNO_NREGS (nregno,
                                   GET_MODE (reload_reg_rtx[r])));
              
              reg_last_reload_reg[nregno] = reload_reg_rtx[r];

              if (nregno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
                for (k = 1; k < nnr; k++)
                  reg_last_reload_reg[nregno + k]
                  = (nr == nnr
                     ? gen_rtx_REG (reg_raw_mode[REGNO (reload_reg_rtx[r]) + k],
                                REGNO (reload_reg_rtx[r]) + k)
                     : 0);

              /* Unless we inherited this reload, show we haven't
                 recently done a store.  */
              if (! reload_inherited[r])
                spill_reg_store[i] = 0;

              for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
                {
                  CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead, i + k);
                  reg_reloaded_contents[i + k]
                  = (nregno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER || nr != nnr
                     ? nregno
                     : nregno + k);
                  reg_reloaded_insn[i + k] = insn;
                  SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i + k);
                }
            }
          }

        /* However, if part of the reload reaches the end, then we must
           invalidate the old info for the part that survives to the end.  */
        else if (part_reaches_end)
          {
            for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
            if (reload_reg_reaches_end_p (i + k,
                                    reload_opnum[r],
                                    reload_when_needed[r]))
              CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i + k);
          }
      }

      /* The following if-statement was #if 0'd in 1.34 (or before...).
       It's reenabled in 1.35 because supposedly nothing else
       deals with this problem.  */

      /* If a register gets output-reloaded from a non-spill register,
       that invalidates any previous reloaded copy of it.
       But forget_old_reloads_1 won't get to see it, because
       it thinks only about the original insn.  So invalidate it here.  */
      if (i < 0 && reload_out[r] != 0 && GET_CODE (reload_out[r]) == REG)
      {
        register int nregno = REGNO (reload_out[r]);
        if (nregno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
          reg_last_reload_reg[nregno] = 0;
        else
          {
            int num_regs = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (nregno,GET_MODE (reload_out[r]));

            while (num_regs-- > 0)
            reg_last_reload_reg[nregno + num_regs] = 0;
          }
      }
    }
  IOR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_dead, reg_reloaded_died);
}

/* Emit code to perform a reload from IN (which may be a reload register) to
   OUT (which may also be a reload register).  IN or OUT is from operand
   OPNUM with reload type TYPE. 

   Returns first insn emitted.  */

rtx
gen_reload (out, in, opnum, type)
     rtx out;
     rtx in;
     int opnum;
     enum reload_type type;
{
  rtx last = get_last_insn ();
  rtx tem;

  /* If IN is a paradoxical SUBREG, remove it and try to put the
     opposite SUBREG on OUT.  Likewise for a paradoxical SUBREG on OUT.  */
  if (GET_CODE (in) == SUBREG
      && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (in))
        > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (in))))
      && (tem = gen_lowpart_common (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (in)), out)) != 0)
    in = SUBREG_REG (in), out = tem;
  else if (GET_CODE (out) == SUBREG
      && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (out))
        > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (out))))
      && (tem = gen_lowpart_common (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (out)), in)) != 0)
    out = SUBREG_REG (out), in = tem;

  /* How to do this reload can get quite tricky.  Normally, we are being
     asked to reload a simple operand, such as a MEM, a constant, or a pseudo
     register that didn't get a hard register.  In that case we can just
     call emit_move_insn.

     We can also be asked to reload a PLUS that adds a register or a MEM to
     another register, constant or MEM.  This can occur during frame pointer
     elimination and while reloading addresses.  This case is handled by
     trying to emit a single insn to perform the add.  If it is not valid,
     we use a two insn sequence.

     Finally, we could be called to handle an 'o' constraint by putting
     an address into a register.  In that case, we first try to do this
     with a named pattern of "reload_load_address".  If no such pattern
     exists, we just emit a SET insn and hope for the best (it will normally
     be valid on machines that use 'o').

     This entire process is made complex because reload will never
     process the insns we generate here and so we must ensure that
     they will fit their constraints and also by the fact that parts of
     IN might be being reloaded separately and replaced with spill registers.
     Because of this, we are, in some sense, just guessing the right approach
     here.  The one listed above seems to work.

     ??? At some point, this whole thing needs to be rethought.  */

  if (GET_CODE (in) == PLUS
      && (GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 0)) == REG
        || GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 0)) == SUBREG
        || GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 0)) == MEM)
      && (GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 1)) == REG
        || GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 1)) == SUBREG
        || CONSTANT_P (XEXP (in, 1))
        || GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 1)) == MEM))
    {
      /* We need to compute the sum of a register or a MEM and another
       register, constant, or MEM, and put it into the reload
       register.  The best possible way of doing this is if the machine
       has a three-operand ADD insn that accepts the required operands.

       The simplest approach is to try to generate such an insn and see if it
       is recognized and matches its constraints.  If so, it can be used.

       It might be better not to actually emit the insn unless it is valid,
       but we need to pass the insn as an operand to `recog' and
       `insn_extract' and it is simpler to emit and then delete the insn if
       not valid than to dummy things up.  */

      rtx op0, op1, tem, insn;
      int code;

      op0 = find_replacement (&XEXP (in, 0));
      op1 = find_replacement (&XEXP (in, 1));

      /* Since constraint checking is strict, commutativity won't be
       checked, so we need to do that here to avoid spurious failure
       if the add instruction is two-address and the second operand
       of the add is the same as the reload reg, which is frequently
       the case.  If the insn would be A = B + A, rearrange it so
       it will be A = A + B as constrain_operands expects.  */

      if (GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 1)) == REG
        && REGNO (out) == REGNO (XEXP (in, 1)))
      tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem;

      if (op0 != XEXP (in, 0) || op1 != XEXP (in, 1))
      in = gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (in), op0, op1);

      insn = emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out, in));
      code = recog_memoized (insn);

      if (code >= 0)
      {
        insn_extract (insn);
        /* We want constrain operands to treat this insn strictly in
           its validity determination, i.e., the way it would after reload
           has completed.  */
        if (constrain_operands (code, 1))
          return insn;
      }

      delete_insns_since (last);

      /* If that failed, we must use a conservative two-insn sequence.
       use move to copy constant, MEM, or pseudo register to the reload
       register since "move" will be able to handle an arbitrary operand,
       unlike add which can't, in general.  Then add the registers.

       If there is another way to do this for a specific machine, a
       DEFINE_PEEPHOLE should be specified that recognizes the sequence
       we emit below.  */

      if (CONSTANT_P (op1) || GET_CODE (op1) == MEM || GET_CODE (op1) == SUBREG
        || (GET_CODE (op1) == REG
            && REGNO (op1) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER))
      tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem;

      gen_reload (out, op0, opnum, type);

      /* If OP0 and OP1 are the same, we can use OUT for OP1.
       This fixes a problem on the 32K where the stack pointer cannot
       be used as an operand of an add insn.  */

      if (rtx_equal_p (op0, op1))
      op1 = out;

      insn = emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (out, op1));

      /* If that failed, copy the address register to the reload register.
       Then add the constant to the reload register.  */

      code = recog_memoized (insn);

      if (code >= 0)
      {
        insn_extract (insn);
        /* We want constrain operands to treat this insn strictly in
           its validity determination, i.e., the way it would after reload
           has completed.  */
        if (constrain_operands (code, 1))
          {
            /* Add a REG_EQUIV note so that find_equiv_reg can find it.  */
            REG_NOTES (insn)
            = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_EQUIV, in, REG_NOTES (insn));
            return insn;
          }
      }

      delete_insns_since (last);

      gen_reload (out, op1, opnum, type);
      insn = emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (out, op0));
      REG_NOTES (insn) = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_EQUIV, in, REG_NOTES (insn));
    }

#ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
  /* If we need a memory location to do the move, do it that way.  */
  else if (GET_CODE (in) == REG && REGNO (in) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
         && GET_CODE (out) == REG && REGNO (out) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
         && SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (in)),
                               REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (out)),
                               GET_MODE (out)))
    {
      /* Get the memory to use and rewrite both registers to its mode.  */
      rtx loc = get_secondary_mem (in, GET_MODE (out), opnum, type);

      if (GET_MODE (loc) != GET_MODE (out))
      out = gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (loc), REGNO (out));

      if (GET_MODE (loc) != GET_MODE (in))
      in = gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (loc), REGNO (in));

      gen_reload (loc, in, opnum, type);
      gen_reload (out, loc, opnum, type);
    }
#endif

  /* If IN is a simple operand, use gen_move_insn.  */
  else if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (in)) == 'o' || GET_CODE (in) == SUBREG)
    emit_insn (gen_move_insn (out, in));

#ifdef HAVE_reload_load_address
  else if (HAVE_reload_load_address)
    emit_insn (gen_reload_load_address (out, in));
#endif

  /* Otherwise, just write (set OUT IN) and hope for the best.  */
  else
    emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out, in));

  /* Return the first insn emitted.
     We can not just return get_last_insn, because there may have
     been multiple instructions emitted.  Also note that gen_move_insn may
     emit more than one insn itself, so we can not assume that there is one
     insn emitted per emit_insn_before call.  */

  return last ? NEXT_INSN (last) : get_insns ();
}

/* Delete a previously made output-reload
   whose result we now believe is not needed.
   First we double-check.

   INSN is the insn now being processed.
   OUTPUT_RELOAD_INSN is the insn of the output reload.
   J is the reload-number for this insn.  */

static void
delete_output_reload (insn, j, output_reload_insn)
     rtx insn;
     int j;
     rtx output_reload_insn;
{
  register rtx i1;

  /* Get the raw pseudo-register referred to.  */

  rtx reg = reload_in[j];
  while (GET_CODE (reg) == SUBREG)
    reg = SUBREG_REG (reg);

  /* If the pseudo-reg we are reloading is no longer referenced
     anywhere between the store into it and here,
     and no jumps or labels intervene, then the value can get
     here through the reload reg alone.
     Otherwise, give up--return.  */
  for (i1 = NEXT_INSN (output_reload_insn);
       i1 != insn; i1 = NEXT_INSN (i1))
    {
      if (GET_CODE (i1) == CODE_LABEL || GET_CODE (i1) == JUMP_INSN)
      return;
      if ((GET_CODE (i1) == INSN || GET_CODE (i1) == CALL_INSN)
        && reg_mentioned_p (reg, PATTERN (i1)))
      {
        /* If this is just a single USE with an REG_EQUAL note in front
           of INSN, this is no problem, because this mentions just the
           address that we are using here.
           But if there is more than one such USE, the insn might use
           the operand directly, or another reload might do that.
           This is analogous to the count_occurences check in the callers.  */
        int num_occurences = 0;

        while (GET_CODE (i1) == INSN && GET_CODE (PATTERN (i1)) == USE
             && find_reg_note (i1, REG_EQUAL, NULL_RTX))
          {
            num_occurences += rtx_equal_p (reg, XEXP (PATTERN (i1), 0)) != 0;
            i1 = NEXT_INSN (i1);
          }
        if (num_occurences == 1 && i1 == insn)
          break;
        return;
      }
    }

  /* The caller has already checked that REG dies or is set in INSN.
     It has also checked that we are optimizing, and thus some inaccurancies
     in the debugging information are acceptable.
     So we could just delete output_reload_insn.
     But in some cases we can improve the debugging information without
     sacrificing optimization - maybe even improving the code:
     See if the pseudo reg has been completely replaced
     with reload regs.  If so, delete the store insn
     and forget we had a stack slot for the pseudo.  */
  if (reload_out[j] != reload_in[j]
      && REG_N_DEATHS (REGNO (reg)) == 1
      && REG_BASIC_BLOCK (REGNO (reg)) >= 0
      && find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, REGNO (reg)))
    {
      rtx i2;

      /* We know that it was used only between here
       and the beginning of the current basic block.
       (We also know that the last use before INSN was
       the output reload we are thinking of deleting, but never mind that.)
       Search that range; see if any ref remains.  */
      for (i2 = PREV_INSN (insn); i2; i2 = PREV_INSN (i2))
      {
        rtx set = single_set (i2);

        /* Uses which just store in the pseudo don't count,
           since if they are the only uses, they are dead.  */
        if (set != 0 && SET_DEST (set) == reg)
          continue;
        if (GET_CODE (i2) == CODE_LABEL
            || GET_CODE (i2) == JUMP_INSN)
          break;
        if ((GET_CODE (i2) == INSN || GET_CODE (i2) == CALL_INSN)
            && reg_mentioned_p (reg, PATTERN (i2)))
          {
            /* Some other ref remains; just delete the output reload we
             know to be dead.  */
            delete_insn (output_reload_insn);
            return;
          }
      }

      /* Delete the now-dead stores into this pseudo.  */
      for (i2 = PREV_INSN (insn); i2; i2 = PREV_INSN (i2))
      {
        rtx set = single_set (i2);

        if (set != 0 && SET_DEST (set) == reg)
          {
            /* This might be a basic block head,
             thus don't use delete_insn.  */
            PUT_CODE (i2, NOTE);
            NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (i2) = 0;
            NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (i2) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
          }
        if (GET_CODE (i2) == CODE_LABEL
            || GET_CODE (i2) == JUMP_INSN)
          break;
      }

      /* For the debugging info,
       say the pseudo lives in this reload reg.  */
      reg_renumber[REGNO (reg)] = REGNO (reload_reg_rtx[j]);
      alter_reg (REGNO (reg), -1);
    }
  delete_insn (output_reload_insn);

}

/* Output reload-insns to reload VALUE into RELOADREG.
   VALUE is an autoincrement or autodecrement RTX whose operand
   is a register or memory location;
   so reloading involves incrementing that location.

   INC_AMOUNT is the number to increment or decrement by (always positive).
   This cannot be deduced from VALUE.  */

static void
inc_for_reload (reloadreg, value, inc_amount)
     rtx reloadreg;
     rtx value;
     int inc_amount;
{
  /* REG or MEM to be copied and incremented.  */
  rtx incloc = XEXP (value, 0);
  /* Nonzero if increment after copying.  */
  int post = (GET_CODE (value) == POST_DEC || GET_CODE (value) == POST_INC);
  rtx last;
  rtx inc;
  rtx add_insn;
  int code;

  /* No hard register is equivalent to this register after
     inc/dec operation.  If REG_LAST_RELOAD_REG were non-zero,
     we could inc/dec that register as well (maybe even using it for
     the source), but I'm not sure it's worth worrying about.  */
  if (GET_CODE (incloc) == REG)
    reg_last_reload_reg[REGNO (incloc)] = 0;

  if (GET_CODE (value) == PRE_DEC || GET_CODE (value) == POST_DEC)
    inc_amount = - inc_amount;

  inc = GEN_INT (inc_amount);

  /* If this is post-increment, first copy the location to the reload reg.  */
  if (post)
    emit_insn (gen_move_insn (reloadreg, incloc));

  /* See if we can directly increment INCLOC.  Use a method similar to that
     in gen_reload.  */

  last = get_last_insn ();
  add_insn = emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, incloc,
                             gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (incloc),
                                       incloc, inc)));
                                            
  code = recog_memoized (add_insn);
  if (code >= 0)
    {
      insn_extract (add_insn);
      if (constrain_operands (code, 1))
      {
        /* If this is a pre-increment and we have incremented the value
           where it lives, copy the incremented value to RELOADREG to
           be used as an address.  */

        if (! post)
          emit_insn (gen_move_insn (reloadreg, incloc));

        return;
      }
    }

  delete_insns_since (last);

  /* If couldn't do the increment directly, must increment in RELOADREG.
     The way we do this depends on whether this is pre- or post-increment.
     For pre-increment, copy INCLOC to the reload register, increment it
     there, then save back.  */

  if (! post)
    {
      emit_insn (gen_move_insn (reloadreg, incloc));
      emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (reloadreg, inc));
      emit_insn (gen_move_insn (incloc, reloadreg));
    }
  else
    {
      /* Postincrement.
       Because this might be a jump insn or a compare, and because RELOADREG
       may not be available after the insn in an input reload, we must do
       the incrementation before the insn being reloaded for.

       We have already copied INCLOC to RELOADREG.  Increment the copy in
       RELOADREG, save that back, then decrement RELOADREG so it has
       the original value.  */

      emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (reloadreg, inc));
      emit_insn (gen_move_insn (incloc, reloadreg));
      emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (reloadreg, GEN_INT (-inc_amount)));
    }

  return;
}

/* Return 1 if we are certain that the constraint-string STRING allows
   the hard register REG.  Return 0 if we can't be sure of this.  */

static int
constraint_accepts_reg_p (string, reg)
     char *string;
     rtx reg;
{
  int value = 0;
  int regno = true_regnum (reg);
  int c;

  /* Initialize for first alternative.  */
  value = 0;
  /* Check that each alternative contains `g' or `r'.  */
  while (1)
    switch (c = *string++)
      {
      case 0:
      /* If an alternative lacks `g' or `r', we lose.  */
      return value;
      case ',':
      /* If an alternative lacks `g' or `r', we lose.  */
      if (value == 0)
        return 0;
      /* Initialize for next alternative.  */
      value = 0;
      break;
      case 'g':
      case 'r':
      /* Any general reg wins for this alternative.  */
      if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) GENERAL_REGS], regno))
        value = 1;
      break;
      default:
      /* Any reg in specified class wins for this alternative.  */
      {
        enum reg_class class = REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (c);

        if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) class], regno))
          value = 1;
      }
      }
}

/* Return the number of places FIND appears within X, but don't count
   an occurrence if some SET_DEST is FIND.  */

int
count_occurrences (x, find)
     register rtx x, find;
{
  register int i, j;
  register enum rtx_code code;
  register char *format_ptr;
  int count;

  if (x == find)
    return 1;
  if (x == 0)
    return 0;

  code = GET_CODE (x);

  switch (code)
    {
    case REG:
    case QUEUED:
    case CONST_INT:
    case CONST_DOUBLE:
    case SYMBOL_REF:
    case CODE_LABEL:
    case PC:
    case CC0:
      return 0;

    case SET:
      if (SET_DEST (x) == find)
      return count_occurrences (SET_SRC (x), find);
      break;
      
    default:
      break;
    }

  format_ptr = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
  count = 0;

  for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++)
    {
      switch (*format_ptr++)
      {
      case 'e':
        count += count_occurrences (XEXP (x, i), find);
        break;

      case 'E':
        if (XVEC (x, i) != NULL)
          {
            for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
            count += count_occurrences (XVECEXP (x, i, j), find);
          }
        break;
      }
    }
  return count;
}

/* This array holds values which are equivalent to a hard register
   during reload_cse_regs.  Each array element is an EXPR_LIST of
   values.  Each time a hard register is set, we set the corresponding
   array element to the value.  Each time a hard register is copied
   into memory, we add the memory location to the corresponding array
   element.  We don't store values or memory addresses with side
   effects in this array.

   If the value is a CONST_INT, then the mode of the containing
   EXPR_LIST is the mode in which that CONST_INT was referenced.

   We sometimes clobber a specific entry in a list.  In that case, we
   just set XEXP (list-entry, 0) to 0.  */

static rtx *reg_values;

/* This is a preallocated REG rtx which we use as a temporary in
   reload_cse_invalidate_regno, so that we don't need to allocate a
   new one each time through a loop in that function.  */

static rtx invalidate_regno_rtx;

/* This is a set of registers for which we must remove REG_DEAD notes in
   previous insns, because our modifications made them invalid.  That can
   happen if we introduced the register into the current insn, or we deleted
   the current insn which used to set the register.  */

static HARD_REG_SET no_longer_dead_regs;

/* Invalidate any entries in reg_values which depend on REGNO,
   including those for REGNO itself.  This is called if REGNO is
   changing.  If CLOBBER is true, then always forget anything we
   currently know about REGNO.  MODE is the mode of the assignment to
   REGNO, which is used to determine how many hard registers are being
   changed.  If MODE is VOIDmode, then only REGNO is being changed;
   this is used when invalidating call clobbered registers across a
   call.  */

static void
reload_cse_invalidate_regno (regno, mode, clobber)
     int regno;
     enum machine_mode mode;
     int clobber;
{
  int endregno;
  register int i;

  /* Our callers don't always go through true_regnum; we may see a
     pseudo-register here from a CLOBBER or the like.  We probably
     won't ever see a pseudo-register that has a real register number,
     for we check anyhow for safety.  */
  if (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
    regno = reg_renumber[regno];
  if (regno < 0)
    return;

  if (mode == VOIDmode)
    endregno = regno + 1;
  else
    endregno = regno + HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, mode);

  if (clobber)
    for (i = regno; i < endregno; i++)
      reg_values[i] = 0;

  for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
    {
      rtx x;

      for (x = reg_values[i]; x; x = XEXP (x, 1))
      {
        if (XEXP (x, 0) != 0
            && refers_to_regno_p (regno, endregno, XEXP (x, 0), NULL_PTR))
          {
            /* If this is the only entry on the list, clear
                 reg_values[i].  Otherwise, just clear this entry on
                 the list.  */
            if (XEXP (x, 1) == 0 && x == reg_values[i])
            {
              reg_values[i] = 0;
              break;
            }
            XEXP (x, 0) = 0;
          }
      }
    }

  /* We must look at earlier registers, in case REGNO is part of a
     multi word value but is not the first register.  If an earlier
     register has a value in a mode which overlaps REGNO, then we must
     invalidate that earlier register.  Note that we do not need to
     check REGNO or later registers (we must not check REGNO itself,
     because we would incorrectly conclude that there was a conflict).  */

  for (i = 0; i < regno; i++)
    {
      rtx x;

      for (x = reg_values[i]; x; x = XEXP (x, 1))
      {
        if (XEXP (x, 0) != 0)
          {
            PUT_MODE (invalidate_regno_rtx, GET_MODE (x));
            REGNO (invalidate_regno_rtx) = i;
            if (refers_to_regno_p (regno, endregno, invalidate_regno_rtx,
                             NULL_PTR))
            {
              reload_cse_invalidate_regno (i, VOIDmode, 1);
              break;
            }
          }
      }
    }
}

/* The memory at address MEM_BASE is being changed.
   Return whether this change will invalidate VAL.  */

static int
reload_cse_mem_conflict_p (mem_base, val)
     rtx mem_base;
     rtx val;
{
  enum rtx_code code;
  char *fmt;
  int i;

  code = GET_CODE (val);
  switch (code)
    {
      /* Get rid of a few simple cases quickly. */
    case REG:
    case PC:
    case CC0:
    case SCRATCH:
    case CONST:
    case CONST_INT:
    case CONST_DOUBLE:
    case SYMBOL_REF:
    case LABEL_REF:
      return 0;

    case MEM:
      if (GET_MODE (mem_base) == BLKmode
        || GET_MODE (val) == BLKmode)
      return 1;
      if (anti_dependence (val, mem_base))
      return 1;
      /* The address may contain nested MEMs.  */
      break;

    default:
      break;
    }

  fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);

  for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
    {
      if (fmt[i] == 'e')
      {
        if (reload_cse_mem_conflict_p (mem_base, XEXP (val, i)))
          return 1;
      }
      else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
      {
        int j;

        for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (val, i); j++)
          if (reload_cse_mem_conflict_p (mem_base, XVECEXP (val, i, j)))
            return 1;
      }
    }

  return 0;
}

/* Invalidate any entries in reg_values which are changed because of a
   store to MEM_RTX.  If this is called because of a non-const call
   instruction, MEM_RTX is (mem:BLK const0_rtx).  */

static void
reload_cse_invalidate_mem (mem_rtx)
     rtx mem_rtx;
{
  register int i;

  for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
    {
      rtx x;

      for (x = reg_values[i]; x; x = XEXP (x, 1))
      {
        if (XEXP (x, 0) != 0
            && reload_cse_mem_conflict_p (mem_rtx, XEXP (x, 0)))
          {
            /* If this is the only entry on the list, clear
                 reg_values[i].  Otherwise, just clear this entry on
                 the list.  */
            if (XEXP (x, 1) == 0 && x == reg_values[i])
            {
              reg_values[i] = 0;
              break;
            }
            XEXP (x, 0) = 0;
          }
      }
    }
}

/* Invalidate DEST, which is being assigned to or clobbered.  The
   second parameter exists so that this function can be passed to
   note_stores; it is ignored.  */

static void
reload_cse_invalidate_rtx (dest, ignore)
     rtx dest;
     rtx ignore ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
{
  while (GET_CODE (dest) == STRICT_LOW_PART
       || GET_CODE (dest) == SIGN_EXTRACT
       || GET_CODE (dest) == ZERO_EXTRACT
       || GET_CODE (dest) == SUBREG)
    dest = XEXP (dest, 0);

  if (GET_CODE (dest) == REG)
    reload_cse_invalidate_regno (REGNO (dest), GET_MODE (dest), 1);
  else if (GET_CODE (dest) == MEM)
    reload_cse_invalidate_mem (dest);
}

/* Possibly delete death notes on the insns before INSN if modifying INSN
   extended the lifespan of the registers.  */

static void
reload_cse_delete_death_notes (insn)
     rtx insn;
{
  int dreg;

  for (dreg = 0; dreg < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; dreg++)
    {
      rtx trial;

      if (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (no_longer_dead_regs, dreg))
      continue;

      for (trial = prev_nonnote_insn (insn);
         (trial
          && GET_CODE (trial) != CODE_LABEL
          && GET_CODE (trial) != BARRIER);
         trial = prev_nonnote_insn (trial))
      {
        if (find_regno_note (trial, REG_DEAD, dreg))
          {
            remove_death (dreg, trial);
            break;
          }
      }
    }
}

/* Record that the current insn uses hard reg REGNO in mode MODE.  This
   will be used in reload_cse_delete_death_notes to delete prior REG_DEAD
   notes for this register.  */

static void
reload_cse_no_longer_dead (regno, mode)
     int regno;
     enum machine_mode mode;
{
  int nregs = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, mode);
  while (nregs-- > 0)
    {
      SET_HARD_REG_BIT (no_longer_dead_regs, regno);
      regno++;
    }
}


/* Do a very simple CSE pass over the hard registers.

   This function detects no-op moves where we happened to assign two
   different pseudo-registers to the same hard register, and then
   copied one to the other.  Reload will generate a useless
   instruction copying a register to itself.

   This function also detects cases where we load a value from memory
   into two different registers, and (if memory is more expensive than
   registers) changes it to simply copy the first register into the
   second register.  

   Another optimization is performed that scans the operands of each
   instruction to see whether the value is already available in a
   hard register.  It then replaces the operand with the hard register
   if possible, much like an optional reload would.  */

void
reload_cse_regs (first)
     rtx first;
{
  char *firstobj;
  rtx callmem;
  register int i;
  rtx insn;

  init_alias_analysis ();

  reg_values = (rtx *) alloca (FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER * sizeof (rtx));
  bzero ((char *)reg_values, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER * sizeof (rtx));

  /* Create our EXPR_LIST structures on reload_obstack, so that we can
     free them when we are done.  */
  push_obstacks (&reload_obstack, &reload_obstack);
  firstobj = (char *) obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack, 0);

  /* We pass this to reload_cse_invalidate_mem to invalidate all of
     memory for a non-const call instruction.  */
  callmem = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, const0_rtx);

  /* This is used in reload_cse_invalidate_regno to avoid consing a
     new REG in a loop in that function.  */
  invalidate_regno_rtx = gen_rtx_REG (VOIDmode, 0);

  for (insn = first; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
    {
      rtx body;

      if (GET_CODE (insn) == CODE_LABEL)
      {
        /* Forget all the register values at a code label.  We don't
             try to do anything clever around jumps.  */
        for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
          reg_values[i] = 0;

        continue;
      }

#ifdef NON_SAVING_SETJMP 
      if (NON_SAVING_SETJMP && GET_CODE (insn) == NOTE
        && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_SETJMP)
      {
        for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
          reg_values[i] = 0;

        continue;
      }
#endif

      if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (insn)) != 'i')
      continue;

      CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (no_longer_dead_regs);

      /* If this is a call instruction, forget anything stored in a
       call clobbered register, or, if this is not a const call, in
       memory.  */
      if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
      {
        for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
          if (call_used_regs[i])
            reload_cse_invalidate_regno (i, VOIDmode, 1);

        if (! CONST_CALL_P (insn))
          reload_cse_invalidate_mem (callmem);
      }

      body = PATTERN (insn);
      if (GET_CODE (body) == SET)
      {
        int count = 0;
        if (reload_cse_noop_set_p (body, insn))
          {
            PUT_CODE (insn, NOTE);
            NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
            NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (insn) = 0;
            reload_cse_delete_death_notes (insn);

            /* We're done with this insn.  */
            continue;
          }

        /* It's not a no-op, but we can try to simplify it.  */
        CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (no_longer_dead_regs);
        count += reload_cse_simplify_set (body, insn);

        if (count > 0 && apply_change_group ())
          reload_cse_delete_death_notes (insn);
        else if (reload_cse_simplify_operands (insn))
          reload_cse_delete_death_notes (insn);
          
        reload_cse_record_set (body, body);
      }
      else if (GET_CODE (body) == PARALLEL)
      {
        int count = 0;

        /* If every action in a PARALLEL is a noop, we can delete
             the entire PARALLEL.  */
        for (i = XVECLEN (body, 0) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
          if ((GET_CODE (XVECEXP (body, 0, i)) != SET
             || ! reload_cse_noop_set_p (XVECEXP (body, 0, i), insn))
            && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (body, 0, i)) != CLOBBER)
            break;
        if (i < 0)
          {
            PUT_CODE (insn, NOTE);
            NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED;
            NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (insn) = 0;
            reload_cse_delete_death_notes (insn);

            /* We're done with this insn.  */
            continue;
          }
        
        /* It's not a no-op, but we can try to simplify it.  */
        CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (no_longer_dead_regs);
        for (i = XVECLEN (body, 0) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
          if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (body, 0, i)) == SET)
            count += reload_cse_simplify_set (XVECEXP (body, 0, i), insn);

        if (count > 0 && apply_change_group ())
          reload_cse_delete_death_notes (insn);
        else if (reload_cse_simplify_operands (insn))
          reload_cse_delete_death_notes (insn);

        /* Look through the PARALLEL and record the values being
             set, if possible.  Also handle any CLOBBERs.  */
        for (i = XVECLEN (body, 0) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
          {
            rtx x = XVECEXP (body, 0, i);

            if (GET_CODE (x) == SET)
            reload_cse_record_set (x, body);
            else
            note_stores (x, reload_cse_invalidate_rtx);
          }
      }
      else
      note_stores (body, reload_cse_invalidate_rtx);

#ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
      /* Clobber any registers which appear in REG_INC notes.  We
         could keep track of the changes to their values, but it is
         unlikely to help.  */
      {
      rtx x;

      for (x = REG_NOTES (insn); x; x = XEXP (x, 1))
        if (REG_NOTE_KIND (x) == REG_INC)
          reload_cse_invalidate_rtx (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX);
      }
#endif

      /* Look for any CLOBBERs in CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE, but only
         after we have processed the insn.  */
      if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
      {
        rtx x;

        for (x = CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn); x; x = XEXP (x, 1))
          if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == CLOBBER)
            reload_cse_invalidate_rtx (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), NULL_RTX);
      }
    }

  /* Free all the temporary structures we created, and go back to the
     regular obstacks.  */
  obstack_free (&reload_obstack, firstobj);
  pop_obstacks ();
}

/* Return whether the values known for REGNO are equal to VAL.  MODE
   is the mode of the object that VAL is being copied to; this matters
   if VAL is a CONST_INT.  */

static int
reload_cse_regno_equal_p (regno, val, mode)
     int regno;
     rtx val;
     enum machine_mode mode;
{
  rtx x;

  if (val == 0)
    return 0;

  for (x = reg_values[regno]; x; x = XEXP (x, 1))
    if (XEXP (x, 0) != 0
      && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (x, 0), val)
      && (! flag_float_store || GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) != MEM
          || GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x)) != MODE_FLOAT)
      && (GET_CODE (val) != CONST_INT
          || mode == GET_MODE (x)
          || (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))
            /* On a big endian machine if the value spans more than
               one register then this register holds the high part of
               it and we can't use it.

               ??? We should also compare with the high part of the
               value.  */
            && !(WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
                 && HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, GET_MODE (x)) > 1)
            && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode),
                                GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x))))))
      return 1;

  return 0;
}

/* See whether a single set is a noop.  SET is the set instruction we
   are should check, and INSN is the instruction from which it came.  */

static int
reload_cse_noop_set_p (set, insn)
     rtx set;
     rtx insn;
{
  rtx src, dest;
  enum machine_mode dest_mode;
  int dreg, sreg;
  int ret;

  src = SET_SRC (set);
  dest = SET_DEST (set);
  dest_mode = GET_MODE (dest);

  if (side_effects_p (src))
    return 0;

  dreg = true_regnum (dest);
  sreg = true_regnum (src);

  /* Check for setting a register to itself.  In this case, we don't
     have to worry about REG_DEAD notes.  */
  if (dreg >= 0 && dreg == sreg)
    return 1;

  ret = 0;
  if (dreg >= 0)
    {
      /* Check for setting a register to itself.  */
      if (dreg == sreg)
      ret = 1;

      /* Check for setting a register to a value which we already know
         is in the register.  */
      else if (reload_cse_regno_equal_p (dreg, src, dest_mode))
      ret = 1;

      /* Check for setting a register DREG to another register SREG
         where SREG is equal to a value which is already in DREG.  */
      else if (sreg >= 0)
      {
        rtx x;

        for (x = reg_values[sreg]; x; x = XEXP (x, 1))
          {
            rtx tmp;

            if (XEXP (x, 0) == 0)
            continue;

            if (dest_mode == GET_MODE (x))
            tmp = XEXP (x, 0);
            else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (dest_mode)
                   < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)))
            tmp = gen_lowpart_common (dest_mode, XEXP (x, 0));
            else
            continue;

            if (tmp
              && reload_cse_regno_equal_p (dreg, tmp, dest_mode))
            {
              ret = 1;
              break;
            }
          }
      }
    }
  else if (GET_CODE (dest) == MEM)
    {
      /* Check for storing a register to memory when we know that the
         register is equivalent to the memory location. */
      if (sreg >= 0
        && reload_cse_regno_equal_p (sreg, dest, dest_mode)
        && ! side_effects_p (dest))
      ret = 1;
    }

  /* If we can delete this SET, then we need to look for an earlier
     REG_DEAD note on DREG, and remove it if it exists.  */
  if (ret && dreg >= 0)
    {
      if (! find_regno_note (insn, REG_UNUSED, dreg))
      reload_cse_no_longer_dead (dreg, dest_mode);
    }

  return ret;
}

/* Try to simplify a single SET instruction.  SET is the set pattern.
   INSN is the instruction it came from.
   This function only handles one case: if we set a register to a value
   which is not a register, we try to find that value in some other register
   and change the set into a register copy.  */

static int
reload_cse_simplify_set (set, insn)
     rtx set;
     rtx insn;
{
  int dreg;
  rtx src;
  enum machine_mode dest_mode;
  enum reg_class dclass;
  register int i;

  dreg = true_regnum (SET_DEST (set));
  if (dreg < 0)
    return 0;

  src = SET_SRC (set);
  if (side_effects_p (src) || true_regnum (src) >= 0)
    return 0;

  dclass = REGNO_REG_CLASS (dreg);

  /* If memory loads are cheaper than register copies, don't change them.  */
  if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM
      && MEMORY_MOVE_COST (GET_MODE (src), dclass, 1) < 2)
    return 0;

  /* If the constant is cheaper than a register, don't change it.  */
  if (CONSTANT_P (src)
      && rtx_cost (src, SET) < 2)
    return 0;

  dest_mode = GET_MODE (SET_DEST (set));
  for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
    {
      if (i != dreg
        && REGISTER_MOVE_COST (REGNO_REG_CLASS (i), dclass) == 2
        && reload_cse_regno_equal_p (i, src, dest_mode))
      {
        int validated;

        /* Pop back to the real obstacks while changing the insn.  */
        pop_obstacks ();

        validated = validate_change (insn, &SET_SRC (set),
                               gen_rtx_REG (dest_mode, i), 1);

        /* Go back to the obstack we are using for temporary
             storage.  */
        push_obstacks (&reload_obstack, &reload_obstack);

        if (validated && ! find_regno_note (insn, REG_UNUSED, i))
          {
            reload_cse_no_longer_dead (i, dest_mode);
            return 1;
          }
      }
    }
  return 0;
}

/* Try to replace operands in INSN with equivalent values that are already
   in registers.  This can be viewed as optional reloading.  
 
   For each non-register operand in the insn, see if any hard regs are
   known to be equivalent to that operand.  Record the alternatives which
   can accept these hard registers.  Among all alternatives, select the
   ones which are better or equal to the one currently matching, where
   "better" is in terms of '?' and '!' constraints.  Among the remaining
   alternatives, select the one which replaces most operands with
   hard registers.  */

static int
reload_cse_simplify_operands (insn)
     rtx insn;
{
#ifdef REGISTER_CONSTRAINTS
  int insn_code_number, n_operands, n_alternatives;
  int i,j;

  char *constraints[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
  
  /* Vector recording how bad an alternative is.  */
  int *alternative_reject;
  /* Vector recording how many registers can be introduced by choosing
     this alternative.  */
  int *alternative_nregs;
  /* Array of vectors recording, for each operand and each alternative,
     which hard register to substitute, or -1 if the operand should be
     left as it is.  */
  int *op_alt_regno[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
  /* Array of alternatives, sorted in order of decreasing desirability.  */
  int *alternative_order;
  rtx reg = gen_rtx_REG (VOIDmode, -1);
  
  /* Find out some information about this insn.  */
  insn_code_number = recog_memoized (insn);
  /* We don't modify asm instructions.  */
  if (insn_code_number < 0)
    return 0;

  n_operands = insn_n_operands[insn_code_number];
  n_alternatives = insn_n_alternatives[insn_code_number];
  
  if (n_alternatives == 0 || n_operands == 0)
    return 0;
  insn_extract (insn);

  /* Figure out which alternative currently matches.  */
  if (! constrain_operands (insn_code_number, 1))
    fatal_insn_not_found (insn);

  alternative_reject = (int *) alloca (n_alternatives * sizeof (int));
  alternative_nregs = (int *) alloca (n_alternatives * sizeof (int));
  alternative_order = (int *) alloca (n_alternatives * sizeof (int));
  bzero ((char *)alternative_reject, n_alternatives * sizeof (int));
  bzero ((char *)alternative_nregs, n_alternatives * sizeof (int));

  for (i = 0; i < n_operands; i++)
    {
      enum machine_mode mode;
      int regno;
      char *p;

      op_alt_regno[i] = (int *) alloca (n_alternatives * sizeof (int));
      for (j = 0; j < n_alternatives; j++)
      op_alt_regno[i][j] = -1;

      p = constraints[i] = insn_operand_constraint[insn_code_number][i];
      mode = insn_operand_mode[insn_code_number][i];

      /* Add the reject values for each alternative given by the constraints
       for this operand.  */
      j = 0;
      while (*p != '\0')
      {
        char c = *p++;
        if (c == ',')
          j++;
        else if (c == '?')
          alternative_reject[j] += 3;
        else if (c == '!')
          alternative_reject[j] += 300;
      }

      /* We won't change operands which are already registers.  We
       also don't want to modify output operands.  */
      regno = true_regnum (recog_operand[i]);
      if (regno >= 0
        || constraints[i][0] == '='
        || constraints[i][0] == '+')
      continue;

      for (regno = 0; regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; regno++)
      {
        int class = (int) NO_REGS;

        if (! reload_cse_regno_equal_p (regno, recog_operand[i], mode))
          continue;

        REGNO (reg) = regno;
        PUT_MODE (reg, mode);

        /* We found a register equal to this operand.  Now look for all
           alternatives that can accept this register and have not been
           assigned a register they can use yet.  */
        j = 0;
        p = constraints[i];
        for (;;)
          {
            char c = *p++;
            
            switch (c)
            {
            case '=':  case '+':  case '?':
            case '#':  case '&':  case '!':
            case '*':  case '%':  
            case '0':  case '1':  case '2':  case '3':  case '4':
            case 'm':  case '<':  case '>':  case 'V':  case 'o':
            case 'E':  case 'F':  case 'G':  case 'H':
            case 's':  case 'i':  case 'n':
            case 'I':  case 'J':  case 'K':  case 'L':
            case 'M':  case 'N':  case 'O':  case 'P':
#ifdef EXTRA_CONSTRAINT
            case 'Q':  case 'R':  case 'S':  case 'T':  case 'U':
#endif
            case 'p': case 'X':
              /* These don't say anything we care about.  */
              break;

            case 'g': case 'r':
              class = reg_class_subunion[(int) class][(int) GENERAL_REGS];
              break;

            default:
              class
                = reg_class_subunion[(int) class][(int) REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (c)];
              break;

            case ',': case '\0':
              /* See if REGNO fits this alternative, and set it up as the
                 replacement register if we don't have one for this
                 alternative yet and the operand being replaced is not
                 a cheap CONST_INT. */
              if (op_alt_regno[i][j] == -1
                  && reg_fits_class_p (reg, class, 0, mode)
                  && (GET_CODE (recog_operand[i]) != CONST_INT
                    || rtx_cost (recog_operand[i], SET) > rtx_cost (reg, SET)))
                {
                  alternative_nregs[j]++;
                  op_alt_regno[i][j] = regno;
                }
              j++;
              break;
            }

            if (c == '\0')
            break;
          }
      }
    }

  /* Record all alternatives which are better or equal to the currently
     matching one in the alternative_order array.  */
  for (i = j = 0; i < n_alternatives; i++)
    if (alternative_reject[i] <= alternative_reject[which_alternative])
      alternative_order[j++] = i;
  n_alternatives = j;

  /* Sort it.  Given a small number of alternatives, a dumb algorithm
     won't hurt too much.  */
  for (i = 0; i < n_alternatives - 1; i++)
    {
      int best = i;
      int best_reject = alternative_reject[alternative_order[i]];
      int best_nregs = alternative_nregs[alternative_order[i]];
      int tmp;

      for (j = i + 1; j < n_alternatives; j++)
      {
        int this_reject = alternative_reject[alternative_order[j]];
        int this_nregs = alternative_nregs[alternative_order[j]];

        if (this_reject < best_reject
            || (this_reject == best_reject && this_nregs < best_nregs))
          {
            best = j;
            best_reject = this_reject;
            best_nregs = this_nregs;
          }
      }
      
      tmp = alternative_order[best];
      alternative_order[best] = alternative_order[i];
      alternative_order[i] = tmp;
    }
  
  /* Substitute the operands as determined by op_alt_regno for the best
     alternative.  */
  j = alternative_order[0];
  CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (no_longer_dead_regs);

  /* Pop back to the real obstacks while changing the insn.  */
  pop_obstacks ();

  for (i = 0; i < n_operands; i++)
    {
      enum machine_mode mode = insn_operand_mode[insn_code_number][i];
      if (op_alt_regno[i][j] == -1)
      continue;

      reload_cse_no_longer_dead (op_alt_regno[i][j], mode);
      validate_change (insn, recog_operand_loc[i],
                   gen_rtx_REG (mode, op_alt_regno[i][j]), 1);
    }

  for (i = insn_n_dups[insn_code_number] - 1; i >= 0; i--)
    {
      int op = recog_dup_num[i];
      enum machine_mode mode = insn_operand_mode[insn_code_number][op];

      if (op_alt_regno[op][j] == -1)
      continue;

      reload_cse_no_longer_dead (op_alt_regno[op][j], mode);
      validate_change (insn, recog_dup_loc[i],
                   gen_rtx_REG (mode, op_alt_regno[op][j]), 1);
    }

  /* Go back to the obstack we are using for temporary
     storage.  */
  push_obstacks (&reload_obstack, &reload_obstack);

  return apply_change_group ();
#else
  return 0;
#endif
}

/* These two variables are used to pass information from
   reload_cse_record_set to reload_cse_check_clobber.  */

static int reload_cse_check_clobbered;
static rtx reload_cse_check_src;

/* See if DEST overlaps with RELOAD_CSE_CHECK_SRC. If it does, set
   RELOAD_CSE_CHECK_CLOBBERED.  This is called via note_stores.  The
   second argument, which is passed by note_stores, is ignored.  */

static void
reload_cse_check_clobber (dest, ignore)
     rtx dest;
     rtx ignore ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
{
  if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (dest, reload_cse_check_src))
    reload_cse_check_clobbered = 1;
}

/* Record the result of a SET instruction.  SET is the set pattern.
   BODY is the pattern of the insn that it came from.  */

static void
reload_cse_record_set (set, body)
     rtx set;
     rtx body;
{
  rtx dest, src, x;
  int dreg, sreg;
  enum machine_mode dest_mode;

  dest = SET_DEST (set);
  src = SET_SRC (set);
  dreg = true_regnum (dest);
  sreg = true_regnum (src);
  dest_mode = GET_MODE (dest);

  /* Some machines don't define AUTO_INC_DEC, but they still use push
     instructions.  We need to catch that case here in order to
     invalidate the stack pointer correctly.  Note that invalidating
     the stack pointer is different from invalidating DEST.  */
  x = dest;
  while (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG
       || GET_CODE (x) == ZERO_EXTRACT
       || GET_CODE (x) == SIGN_EXTRACT
       || GET_CODE (x) == STRICT_LOW_PART)
    x = XEXP (x, 0);
  if (push_operand (x, GET_MODE (x)))
    {
      reload_cse_invalidate_rtx (stack_pointer_rtx, NULL_RTX);
      reload_cse_invalidate_rtx (dest, NULL_RTX);
      return;
    }

  /* We can only handle an assignment to a register, or a store of a
     register to a memory location.  For other cases, we just clobber
     the destination.  We also have to just clobber if there are side
     effects in SRC or DEST.  */
  if ((dreg < 0 && GET_CODE (dest) != MEM)
      || side_effects_p (src)
      || side_effects_p (dest))
    {
      reload_cse_invalidate_rtx (dest, NULL_RTX);
      return;
    }

#ifdef HAVE_cc0
  /* We don't try to handle values involving CC, because it's a pain
     to keep track of when they have to be invalidated.  */
  if (reg_mentioned_p (cc0_rtx, src)
      || reg_mentioned_p (cc0_rtx, dest))
    {
      reload_cse_invalidate_rtx (dest, NULL_RTX);
      return;
    }
#endif

  /* If BODY is a PARALLEL, then we need to see whether the source of
     SET is clobbered by some other instruction in the PARALLEL.  */
  if (GET_CODE (body) == PARALLEL)
    {
      int i;

      for (i = XVECLEN (body, 0) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
      {
        rtx x;

        x = XVECEXP (body, 0, i);
        if (x == set)
          continue;

        reload_cse_check_clobbered = 0;
        reload_cse_check_src = src;
        note_stores (x, reload_cse_check_clobber);
        if (reload_cse_check_clobbered)
          {
            reload_cse_invalidate_rtx (dest, NULL_RTX);
            return;
          }
      }
    }

  if (dreg >= 0)
    {
      int i;

      /* This is an assignment to a register.  Update the value we
         have stored for the register.  */
      if (sreg >= 0)
      {
        rtx x;

        /* This is a copy from one register to another.  Any values
           which were valid for SREG are now valid for DREG.  If the
           mode changes, we use gen_lowpart_common to extract only
           the part of the value that is copied.  */
        reg_values[dreg] = 0;
        for (x = reg_values[sreg]; x; x = XEXP (x, 1))
          {
            rtx tmp;

            if (XEXP (x, 0) == 0)
            continue;
            if (dest_mode == GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0)))
            tmp = XEXP (x, 0);
            else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (dest_mode)
                    > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0))))
            continue;
            else
            tmp = gen_lowpart_common (dest_mode, XEXP (x, 0));
            if (tmp)
            reg_values[dreg] = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (dest_mode, tmp,
                                          reg_values[dreg]);
          }       
      }
      else
      reg_values[dreg] = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (dest_mode, src, NULL_RTX);

      /* We've changed DREG, so invalidate any values held by other
         registers that depend upon it.  */
      reload_cse_invalidate_regno (dreg, dest_mode, 0);

      /* If this assignment changes more than one hard register,
         forget anything we know about the others.  */
      for (i = 1; i < HARD_REGNO_NREGS (dreg, dest_mode); i++)
      reg_values[dreg + i] = 0;
    }
  else if (GET_CODE (dest) == MEM)
    {
      /* Invalidate conflicting memory locations.  */
      reload_cse_invalidate_mem (dest);

      /* If we're storing a register to memory, add DEST to the list
         in REG_VALUES.  */
      if (sreg >= 0 && ! side_effects_p (dest))
      reg_values[sreg] = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (dest_mode, dest,
                            reg_values[sreg]);
    }
  else
    {
      /* We should have bailed out earlier.  */
      abort ();
    }
}

Generated by  Doxygen 1.6.0   Back to index